e6da37c3b80fc718a6baa421cae35c06d2080183
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
56
57 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
59 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
60 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
61 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
63
64 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
65 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
66 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
67 development.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
88 @sp 2
89 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
90 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
92 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
93
94 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
97 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
100
101 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104 development.''
105 @end titlepage
106 @page
107
108 @ifnottex
109 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
111 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
115 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
116 @value{GDBVN}.
117
118 Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
119
120 @menu
121 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128 * Stack:: Examining the stack
129 * Source:: Examining source files
130 * Data:: Examining data
131 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
132 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
133 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
134
135 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138 * Altering:: Altering execution
139 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
141 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
142 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
146 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
147 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
148 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
149 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
150
151 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
152 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
153
154 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
157 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
158 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
159 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
160 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
161 how you can copy and share GDB
162 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
163 * Index:: Index
164 @end menu
165
166 @end ifnottex
167
168 @contents
169
170 @node Summary
171 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
172
173 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
174 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
175 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
176
177 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
178 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
179
180 @itemize @bullet
181 @item
182 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
183
184 @item
185 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
186
187 @item
188 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
189
190 @item
191 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
192 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
193 @end itemize
194
195 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
196 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
197 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
198
199 @cindex Modula-2
200 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
201 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
202
203 @cindex Pascal
204 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
205 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
206 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
207 syntax.
208
209 @cindex Fortran
210 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
211 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
212 underscore.
213
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
215 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
216
217 @menu
218 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
219 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
220 @end menu
221
222 @node Free Software
223 @unnumberedsec Free software
224
225 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
226 General Public License
227 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
228 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
229 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
230 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
231 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
232 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
233
234 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
235 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
236 from anyone else.
237
238 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
239
240 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
241 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
242 include with the free software. Many of our most important
243 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
244 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
245 when an important free software package does not come with a free
246 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
247 gaps today.
248
249 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
250 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
251 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
252 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
253 them from the free software world.
254
255 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
256 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
257 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
258 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
259 contract to make it non-free.
260
261 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
262 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
263 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
264 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
265 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
266 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
267 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
268
269 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
270 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
271 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
272 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
273
274 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
275 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
276 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
277 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
278 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
279 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
280 community.
281
282 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
283 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
284 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
285 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
286 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
287 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
288 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
289 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
290 of the manual.
291
292 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
293 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
294 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
295 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
296 manual to replace it.
297
298 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
299 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
300 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
301 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
302 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
303 the free software community.
304
305 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
306 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
307 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
308 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
309 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
310 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
311 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
312 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
313 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
314
315 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
316 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
317 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
318 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
319 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
320 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
321 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
322 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
323
324 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
325 published by other publishers, at
326 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
327
328 @node Contributors
329 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
330
331 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
332 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
333 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
334 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
335 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
336 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
337 blow-by-blow account.
338
339 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
340
341 @quotation
342 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
343 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
344 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
345 @end quotation
346
347 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
348 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
349 releases:
350 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
351 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
352 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
353 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
354 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
355 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
356 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
357 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
358 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
359
360 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
361 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
362
363 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
364 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
365 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
366 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
367 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
368
369 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
370 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
371 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
372
373 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
374 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
375
376 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
377
378 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
379 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
380 support.
381 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
382 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
383 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
384 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
385 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
386 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
387 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
388 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
389 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
390 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
391 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
392 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
393 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
394 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
395 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
396 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
397
398 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
399
400 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401 libraries.
402
403 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404 about several machine instruction sets.
405
406 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409 and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412 command-line editing and command history.
413
414 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
416
417 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
418 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
419 symbols.
420
421 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
422 Super-H processors.
423
424 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
426 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
427
428 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
429
430 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
431
432 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
433
434 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
435 watchpoints.
436
437 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
438
439 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
440
441 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
442 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
443
444 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
445 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
446 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
447 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
448 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
449 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
450 information in this manual.
451
452 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
453 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
454
455 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
456 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
457 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
458 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
459 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
460 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
461 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
462 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
463 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
464 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
465 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
466 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
467 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
468 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
469 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
470
471 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
472 Hat.
473
474 @node Sample Session
475 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
476
477 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
478 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
479 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
480
481 @iftex
482 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
483 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
484 @end iftex
485
486 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
487 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
488
489 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
490 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
491 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
492 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
493 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
494 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
495 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
496 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
497 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
498
499 @smallexample
500 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
501 $ @b{./m4}
502 @b{define(foo,0000)}
503
504 @b{foo}
505 0000
506 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
507
508 @b{bar}
509 0000
510 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
511
512 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
513 @b{baz}
514 @b{C-d}
515 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
516 @end smallexample
517
518 @noindent
519 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
520
521 @smallexample
522 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
523 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
524 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
525 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
526 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
527 the conditions.
528 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
529 for details.
530
531 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
532 (@value{GDBP})
533 @end smallexample
534
535 @noindent
536 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
537 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
538 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
539 that examples fit in this manual.
540
541 @smallexample
542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
543 @end smallexample
544
545 @noindent
546 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
547 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
548 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
549 @code{break} command.
550
551 @smallexample
552 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
553 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
554 @end smallexample
555
556 @noindent
557 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
558 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
559 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
560
561 @smallexample
562 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
563 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
564 @b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566 @b{foo}
567 0000
568 @end smallexample
569
570 @noindent
571 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
572 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
573 context where it stops.
574
575 @smallexample
576 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
577
578 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
579 at builtin.c:879
580 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
585 the next line of the current function.
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
589 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
590 : nil,
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
595 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
596 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
597 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
598
599 @smallexample
600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
601 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
602 at input.c:530
603 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
604 @end smallexample
605
606 @noindent
607 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
608 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
609 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
610 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
611 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
612 stack frame for each active subroutine.
613
614 @smallexample
615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
616 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
617 at input.c:530
618 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
619 at builtin.c:882
620 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
621 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
622 at macro.c:71
623 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
624 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
625 @end smallexample
626
627 @noindent
628 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
629 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
630 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
635 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
636 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
637 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
639 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
640 : xstrdup(rq);
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
647 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
648 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
649 (@code{print}) to see their values.
650
651 @smallexample
652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
653 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
655 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
660 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
661 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
665 533 xfree(rquote);
666 534
667 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
668 : xstrdup (lq);
669 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
670 : xstrdup (rq);
671 537
672 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
673 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
674 540 @}
675 541
676 542 void
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
681 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
682
683 @smallexample
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
687 540 @}
688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
689 $3 = 9
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
691 $4 = 7
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
696 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
697 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
698 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
699 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
700 assignments.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
704 $5 = 7
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
706 $6 = 9
707 @end smallexample
708
709 @noindent
710 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
711 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
712 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
713 example that caused trouble initially:
714
715 @smallexample
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
717 Continuing.
718
719 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
720
721 baz
722 0000
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
727 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
728 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
729
730 @smallexample
731 @b{C-d}
732 Program exited normally.
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
737 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
738 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
739
740 @smallexample
741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @node Invocation
745 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
746
747 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
748 The essentials are:
749 @itemize @bullet
750 @item
751 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
752 @item
753 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
754 @end itemize
755
756 @menu
757 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
758 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
759 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
760 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
761 @end menu
762
763 @node Invoking GDB
764 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
765
766 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
767 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
768
769 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
770 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
771
772 The command-line options described here are designed
773 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
774 options may effectively be unavailable.
775
776 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
777 specifying an executable program:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @noindent
784 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
785 specified:
786
787 @smallexample
788 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
789 @end smallexample
790
791 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
792 to debug a running process:
793
794 @smallexample
795 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
796 @end smallexample
797
798 @noindent
799 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
800 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
801
802 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
803 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
804 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
805 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
806 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
807
808 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
809 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
810 option processing.
811 @smallexample
812 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
813 @end smallexample
814 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
815 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
816
817 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
818 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} -silent
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @noindent
825 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
826 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
827
828 @noindent
829 Type
830
831 @smallexample
832 @value{GDBP} -help
833 @end smallexample
834
835 @noindent
836 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
837 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
838
839 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
840 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
841 @samp{-x} option is used.
842
843
844 @menu
845 * File Options:: Choosing files
846 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
847 @end menu
848
849 @node File Options
850 @subsection Choosing files
851
852 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
853 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
854 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
855 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
856 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
857 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
858 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
859 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
860 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
861 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
862 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
863 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
864 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
865
866 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
867 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
868 argument and ignore it.
869
870 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
871 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
872 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
873 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
874 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
875
876 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
877 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
878 @c it.
879
880 @table @code
881 @item -symbols @var{file}
882 @itemx -s @var{file}
883 @cindex @code{--symbols}
884 @cindex @code{-s}
885 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
886
887 @item -exec @var{file}
888 @itemx -e @var{file}
889 @cindex @code{--exec}
890 @cindex @code{-e}
891 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
892 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
893
894 @item -se @var{file}
895 @cindex @code{--se}
896 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
897 file.
898
899 @item -core @var{file}
900 @itemx -c @var{file}
901 @cindex @code{--core}
902 @cindex @code{-c}
903 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
904
905 @item -c @var{number}
906 @item -pid @var{number}
907 @itemx -p @var{number}
908 @cindex @code{--pid}
909 @cindex @code{-p}
910 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
911 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
912 file named @var{number}.
913
914 @item -command @var{file}
915 @itemx -x @var{file}
916 @cindex @code{--command}
917 @cindex @code{-x}
918 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
919 Files,, Command files}.
920
921 @item -directory @var{directory}
922 @itemx -d @var{directory}
923 @cindex @code{--directory}
924 @cindex @code{-d}
925 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
926
927 @item -m
928 @itemx -mapped
929 @cindex @code{--mapped}
930 @cindex @code{-m}
931 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
932 supported on all systems.}@*
933 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
934 system call, you can use this option
935 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
936 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
937 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
938 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
939 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
940 the symbol table from the executable program.
941
942 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
943 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
944 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
945
946 @item -r
947 @itemx -readnow
948 @cindex @code{--readnow}
949 @cindex @code{-r}
950 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
951 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
952 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
953
954 @end table
955
956 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
957 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
958 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
959 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
960 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
961
962 @smallexample
963 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
964 @end smallexample
965
966 @node Mode Options
967 @subsection Choosing modes
968
969 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
970 batch mode or quiet mode.
971
972 @table @code
973 @item -nx
974 @itemx -n
975 @cindex @code{--nx}
976 @cindex @code{-n}
977 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
978 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
979 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
980 files}.
981
982 @item -quiet
983 @itemx -silent
984 @itemx -q
985 @cindex @code{--quiet}
986 @cindex @code{--silent}
987 @cindex @code{-q}
988 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
989 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
990
991 @item -batch
992 @cindex @code{--batch}
993 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
994 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
995 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
996 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
997 in the command files.
998
999 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1000 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1001 make this more useful, the message
1002
1003 @smallexample
1004 Program exited normally.
1005 @end smallexample
1006
1007 @noindent
1008 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1009 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1010 mode.
1011
1012 @item -nowindows
1013 @itemx -nw
1014 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1015 @cindex @code{-nw}
1016 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1017 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1018 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1019
1020 @item -windows
1021 @itemx -w
1022 @cindex @code{--windows}
1023 @cindex @code{-w}
1024 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1025 used if possible.
1026
1027 @item -cd @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--cd}
1029 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1030 instead of the current directory.
1031
1032 @item -fullname
1033 @itemx -f
1034 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1035 @cindex @code{-f}
1036 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1037 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1038 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1039 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1040 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1041 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1042 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1043 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1044 frame.
1045
1046 @item -epoch
1047 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1048 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1049 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1050 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1051 separate window.
1052
1053 @item -annotate @var{level}
1054 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1055 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1056 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1057 (@pxref{Annotations}).
1058 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1059 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1060 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1061 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1062 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1063
1064 @item -async
1065 @cindex @code{--async}
1066 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1067 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1068 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1069 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1070 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1071 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1072 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1073 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1074 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1075 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1076 yet.)
1077 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1078 @c should be removed.
1079
1080 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1081 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1082 @samp{-noasync} option.
1083
1084 @item -noasync
1085 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1086 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1087
1088 @item --args
1089 @cindex @code{--args}
1090 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1091 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1092 This option stops option processing.
1093
1094 @item -baud @var{bps}
1095 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1096 @cindex @code{--baud}
1097 @cindex @code{-b}
1098 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1099 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1100
1101 @item -tty @var{device}
1102 @itemx -t @var{device}
1103 @cindex @code{--tty}
1104 @cindex @code{-t}
1105 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1106 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1107
1108 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1109 @item -tui
1110 @cindex @code{--tui}
1111 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1112 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1113 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1114 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1115 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1116 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1117
1118 @c @item -xdb
1119 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1120 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1121 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1122 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1123 @c systems.
1124
1125 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1126 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1127 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1128 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1129 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1130 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1131
1132 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1133 @value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1134 (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1135 interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1136 @samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1137 are not supported.
1138
1139 @item -write
1140 @cindex @code{--write}
1141 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1142 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1143 (@pxref{Patching}).
1144
1145 @item -statistics
1146 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1147 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1148 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1149
1150 @item -version
1151 @cindex @code{--version}
1152 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1153 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1154
1155 @end table
1156
1157 @node Quitting GDB
1158 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1159 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1160 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1161
1162 @table @code
1163 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1164 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1165 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1166 @itemx q
1167 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1168 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1169 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1170 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1171 error code.
1172 @end table
1173
1174 @cindex interrupt
1175 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1176 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1177 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1178 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1179 until a time when it is safe.
1180
1181 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1182 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1183 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1184
1185 @node Shell Commands
1186 @section Shell commands
1187
1188 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1189 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1190 just use the @code{shell} command.
1191
1192 @table @code
1193 @kindex shell
1194 @cindex shell escape
1195 @item shell @var{command string}
1196 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1197 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1198 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1199 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1200 @end table
1201
1202 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1203 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1204 @value{GDBN}:
1205
1206 @table @code
1207 @kindex make
1208 @cindex calling make
1209 @item make @var{make-args}
1210 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1211 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1212 @end table
1213
1214 @node Logging output
1215 @section Logging output
1216 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1217
1218 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1219 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1220
1221 @table @code
1222 @kindex set logging
1223 @item set logging on
1224 Enable logging.
1225 @item set logging off
1226 Disable logging.
1227 @item set logging file @var{file}
1228 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1229 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1230 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1231 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1232 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1233 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1234 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1235 @kindex show logging
1236 @item show logging
1237 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1238 @end table
1239
1240 @node Commands
1241 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1242
1243 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1244 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1245 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1246 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1247 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1248
1249 @menu
1250 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1251 * Completion:: Command completion
1252 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1253 @end menu
1254
1255 @node Command Syntax
1256 @section Command syntax
1257
1258 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1259 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1260 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1261 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1262 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1263 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1264
1265 @cindex abbreviation
1266 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1267 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1268 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1269 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1270 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1271 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1272 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1273
1274 @cindex repeating commands
1275 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1276 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1277 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1278 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1279 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1280 repeat.
1281
1282 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1283 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1284 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1285
1286 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1287 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1288 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1289 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1290 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1291
1292 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1293 @cindex comment
1294 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1295 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1296 Files,,Command files}).
1297
1298 @cindex repeating command sequences
1299 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1300 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1301 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1302 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1303 for editing.
1304
1305 @node Completion
1306 @section Command completion
1307
1308 @cindex completion
1309 @cindex word completion
1310 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1311 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1312 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1313 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1314
1315 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1316 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1317 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1318 enter it). For example, if you type
1319
1320 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1321 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1322 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1323 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1324 @smallexample
1325 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1326 @end smallexample
1327
1328 @noindent
1329 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1330 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 @noindent
1337 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1338 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1339 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1340 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1341 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1342 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1343
1344 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1345 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1346 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1347 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1348 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1349 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1350 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1351 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1352 example:
1353
1354 @smallexample
1355 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1356 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1357 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1358 make_abs_section make_function_type
1359 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1360 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1361 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1362 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1363 @end smallexample
1364
1365 @noindent
1366 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1367 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1368 command.
1369
1370 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1371 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1372 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1373 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1374 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1375
1376 @cindex quotes in commands
1377 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1378 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1379 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1380 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1381 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1382 @value{GDBN} commands.
1383
1384 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1385 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1386 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1387 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1388 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1389 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1390 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1391 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1392 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1393 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1394 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1395
1396 @smallexample
1397 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1398 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1399 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1400 @end smallexample
1401
1402 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1403 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1404 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1405 place:
1406
1407 @smallexample
1408 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1409 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1410 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1411 @end smallexample
1412
1413 @noindent
1414 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1415 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1416 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1417
1418 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1419 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1420 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1421 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1422
1423
1424 @node Help
1425 @section Getting help
1426 @cindex online documentation
1427 @kindex help
1428
1429 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1430 using the command @code{help}.
1431
1432 @table @code
1433 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1434 @item help
1435 @itemx h
1436 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1437 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1438
1439 @smallexample
1440 (@value{GDBP}) help
1441 List of classes of commands:
1442
1443 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1444 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1445 data -- Examining data
1446 files -- Specifying and examining files
1447 internals -- Maintenance commands
1448 obscure -- Obscure features
1449 running -- Running the program
1450 stack -- Examining the stack
1451 status -- Status inquiries
1452 support -- Support facilities
1453 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1454 stopping the program
1455 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1456
1457 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1458 commands in that class.
1459 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1460 documentation.
1461 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1462 (@value{GDBP})
1463 @end smallexample
1464 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1465
1466 @item help @var{class}
1467 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1468 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1469 help display for the class @code{status}:
1470
1471 @smallexample
1472 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1473 Status inquiries.
1474
1475 List of commands:
1476
1477 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1478 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1479 info -- Generic command for showing things
1480 about the program being debugged
1481 show -- Generic command for showing things
1482 about the debugger
1483
1484 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1485 documentation.
1486 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1487 (@value{GDBP})
1488 @end smallexample
1489
1490 @item help @var{command}
1491 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1492 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1493
1494 @kindex apropos
1495 @item apropos @var{args}
1496 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1497 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1498 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1499
1500 @smallexample
1501 apropos reload
1502 @end smallexample
1503
1504 @noindent
1505 results in:
1506
1507 @smallexample
1508 @c @group
1509 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1510 multiple times in one run
1511 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1512 multiple times in one run
1513 @c @end group
1514 @end smallexample
1515
1516 @kindex complete
1517 @item complete @var{args}
1518 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1519 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1520 command you want completed. For example:
1521
1522 @smallexample
1523 complete i
1524 @end smallexample
1525
1526 @noindent results in:
1527
1528 @smallexample
1529 @group
1530 if
1531 ignore
1532 info
1533 inspect
1534 @end group
1535 @end smallexample
1536
1537 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1538 @end table
1539
1540 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1541 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1542 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1543 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1544 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1545 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1546
1547 @c @group
1548 @table @code
1549 @kindex info
1550 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1551 @item info
1552 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1553 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1554 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1555 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1556 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1557 @w{@code{help info}}.
1558
1559 @kindex set
1560 @item set
1561 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1562 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1563 @code{set prompt $}.
1564
1565 @kindex show
1566 @item show
1567 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1568 @value{GDBN} itself.
1569 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1570 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1571 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1572 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1573
1574 @kindex info set
1575 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1576 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1577 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1578 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1579 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1580 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1581 @end table
1582 @c @end group
1583
1584 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1585 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1586
1587 @table @code
1588 @kindex show version
1589 @cindex version number
1590 @item show version
1591 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1592 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1593 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1594 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1595 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1596 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1597 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1598 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1599 @value{GDBN}.
1600
1601 @kindex show copying
1602 @item show copying
1603 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1604
1605 @kindex show warranty
1606 @item show warranty
1607 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1608 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1609
1610 @end table
1611
1612 @node Running
1613 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1614
1615 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1616 debugging information when you compile it.
1617
1618 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1619 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1620 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1621 kill a child process.
1622
1623 @menu
1624 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1625 * Starting:: Starting your program
1626 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1627 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1628
1629 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1630 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1631 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1632 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1633
1634 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1635 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1636 @end menu
1637
1638 @node Compilation
1639 @section Compiling for debugging
1640
1641 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1642 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1643 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1644 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1645 and addresses in the executable code.
1646
1647 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1648 the compiler.
1649
1650 Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1651 the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1652 because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1653 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1654 options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1655 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1656 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1657 to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1658 @option{-g} alone.
1659
1660 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1661 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1662 executables containing debugging information.
1663
1664 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1665 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1666 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1667 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1668 in pushing your luck.
1669
1670 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1671 @cindex debugging optimized code
1672 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1673 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1674 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1675 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1676 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1677 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1678
1679 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1680 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1681 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1682 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1683
1684 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1685 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1686 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1687
1688 @need 2000
1689 @node Starting
1690 @section Starting your program
1691 @cindex starting
1692 @cindex running
1693
1694 @table @code
1695 @kindex run
1696 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1697 @item run
1698 @itemx r
1699 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1700 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1701 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1702 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1703 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1704
1705 @end table
1706
1707 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1708 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1709 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1710 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1711
1712 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1713 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1714 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1715 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1716 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1717 divided into four categories:
1718
1719 @table @asis
1720 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1721 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1722 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1723 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1724 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1725 the arguments.
1726 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1727 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1728 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1729
1730 @item The @emph{environment.}
1731 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1732 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1733 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1734 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1735
1736 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1737 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1738 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1739 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1740
1741 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1742 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1743 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1744 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1745 set a different device for your program.
1746 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1747
1748 @cindex pipes
1749 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1750 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1751 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1752 wrong program.
1753 @end table
1754
1755 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1756 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1757 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1758 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1759 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1760
1761 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1762 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1763 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1764 your current breakpoints.
1765
1766 @node Arguments
1767 @section Your program's arguments
1768
1769 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1770 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1771 @code{run} command.
1772 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1773 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1774 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1775 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1776 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1777
1778 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1779 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1780 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1781 the program, not by the shell.
1782
1783 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1784 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1785
1786 @table @code
1787 @kindex set args
1788 @item set args
1789 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1790 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1791 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1792 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1793 it again without arguments.
1794
1795 @kindex show args
1796 @item show args
1797 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1798 @end table
1799
1800 @node Environment
1801 @section Your program's environment
1802
1803 @cindex environment (of your program)
1804 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1805 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1806 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1807 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1808 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1809 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1810 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1811
1812 @table @code
1813 @kindex path
1814 @item path @var{directory}
1815 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1816 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1817 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1818 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1819 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1820 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1821 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1822
1823 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1824 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1825 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1826 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1827 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1828 @var{directory} to the search path.
1829 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1830 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1831
1832 @kindex show paths
1833 @item show paths
1834 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1835 environment variable).
1836
1837 @kindex show environment
1838 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1839 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1840 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1841 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1842 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1843
1844 @kindex set environment
1845 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1846 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1847 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1848 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1849 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1850 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1851 null value.
1852 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1853 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1854
1855 For example, this command:
1856
1857 @smallexample
1858 set env USER = foo
1859 @end smallexample
1860
1861 @noindent
1862 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1863 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1864 are not actually required.)
1865
1866 @kindex unset environment
1867 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1868 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1869 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1870 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1871 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1872 @end table
1873
1874 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1875 the shell indicated
1876 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1877 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1878 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1879 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1880 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1881 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1882 @file{.profile}.
1883
1884 @node Working Directory
1885 @section Your program's working directory
1886
1887 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1888 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1889 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1890 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1891 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1892 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1893
1894 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1895 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1896 specify files}.
1897
1898 @table @code
1899 @kindex cd
1900 @item cd @var{directory}
1901 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1902
1903 @kindex pwd
1904 @item pwd
1905 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1906 @end table
1907
1908 @node Input/Output
1909 @section Your program's input and output
1910
1911 @cindex redirection
1912 @cindex i/o
1913 @cindex terminal
1914 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1915 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1916 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1917 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1918 running your program.
1919
1920 @table @code
1921 @kindex info terminal
1922 @item info terminal
1923 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1924 program is using.
1925 @end table
1926
1927 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1928 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1929
1930 @smallexample
1931 run > outfile
1932 @end smallexample
1933
1934 @noindent
1935 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1936
1937 @kindex tty
1938 @cindex controlling terminal
1939 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1940 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1941 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1942 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1943 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1944
1945 @smallexample
1946 tty /dev/ttyb
1947 @end smallexample
1948
1949 @noindent
1950 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1951 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1952 that as their controlling terminal.
1953
1954 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1955 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1956 terminal.
1957
1958 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1959 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1960 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1961
1962 @node Attach
1963 @section Debugging an already-running process
1964 @kindex attach
1965 @cindex attach
1966
1967 @table @code
1968 @item attach @var{process-id}
1969 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1970 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1971 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1972 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1973 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1974
1975 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1976 executing the command.
1977 @end table
1978
1979 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1980 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1981 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1982 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1983
1984 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1985 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1986 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1987 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1988 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1989 Specify Files}.
1990
1991 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1992 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1993 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1994 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1995 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1996 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1997 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex detach
2001 @item detach
2002 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2003 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2004 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2005 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2006 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2007 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2008 executing the command.
2009 @end table
2010
2011 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2012 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2013 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2014 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2015 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2016 messages}).
2017
2018 @node Kill Process
2019 @section Killing the child process
2020
2021 @table @code
2022 @kindex kill
2023 @item kill
2024 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2025 @end table
2026
2027 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2028 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2029 is running.
2030
2031 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2032 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2033 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2034 outside the debugger.
2035
2036 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2037 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2038 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2039 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2040 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2041 breakpoint settings).
2042
2043 @node Threads
2044 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2045
2046 @cindex threads of execution
2047 @cindex multiple threads
2048 @cindex switching threads
2049 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2050 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2051 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2052 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2053 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2054 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2055 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2056
2057 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2058 programs:
2059
2060 @itemize @bullet
2061 @item automatic notification of new threads
2062 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2063 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2064 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2065 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2066 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2067 @end itemize
2068
2069 @quotation
2070 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2071 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2072 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2073 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2074 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2075 like this:
2076
2077 @smallexample
2078 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2079 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2080 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2081 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2082 @end smallexample
2083 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2084 @c doesn't support threads"?
2085 @end quotation
2086
2087 @cindex focus of debugging
2088 @cindex current thread
2089 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2090 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2091 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2092 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2093 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2094
2095 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2096 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2097 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2098 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2099 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2100 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2101 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2102 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2103 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2104 LynxOS, you might see
2105
2106 @smallexample
2107 [New process 35 thread 27]
2108 @end smallexample
2109
2110 @noindent
2111 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2112 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2113 further qualifier.
2114
2115 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2116 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2117 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2118 @c program?
2119 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2120 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2121 @c threads ab initio?
2122
2123 @cindex thread number
2124 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2125 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2126 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2127
2128 @table @code
2129 @kindex info threads
2130 @item info threads
2131 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2132 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2133
2134 @enumerate
2135 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2136
2137 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2138
2139 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2140 @end enumerate
2141
2142 @noindent
2143 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2144 indicates the current thread.
2145
2146 For example,
2147 @end table
2148 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2149
2150 @smallexample
2151 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2152 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2153 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2154 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2155 at threadtest.c:68
2156 @end smallexample
2157
2158 On HP-UX systems:
2159
2160 @cindex thread number
2161 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2162 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2163 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2164 thread in your program.
2165
2166 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2167 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2168 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2169 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2170 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2171 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2172 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2173 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2174 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2175 HP-UX, you see
2176
2177 @smallexample
2178 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2179 @end smallexample
2180
2181 @noindent
2182 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2183
2184 @table @code
2185 @kindex info threads
2186 @item info threads
2187 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2188 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2189
2190 @enumerate
2191 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2192
2193 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2194
2195 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2196 @end enumerate
2197
2198 @noindent
2199 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2200 indicates the current thread.
2201
2202 For example,
2203 @end table
2204 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2205
2206 @smallexample
2207 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2208 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2209 at quicksort.c:137
2210 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2211 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2212 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2213 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2214 @end smallexample
2215
2216 @table @code
2217 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2218 @item thread @var{threadno}
2219 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2220 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2221 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2222 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2223 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2224
2225 @smallexample
2226 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2227 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2228 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2229 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2230 @end smallexample
2231
2232 @noindent
2233 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2234 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2235 threads.
2236
2237 @kindex thread apply
2238 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2239 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2240 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2241 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2242 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2243 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2244 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2245 @end table
2246
2247 @cindex automatic thread selection
2248 @cindex switching threads automatically
2249 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2250 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2251 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2252 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2253 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2254 thread.
2255
2256 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2257 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2258 programs with multiple threads.
2259
2260 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2261 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2262
2263 @node Processes
2264 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2265
2266 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2267 @cindex multiple processes
2268 @cindex processes, multiple
2269 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2270 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2271 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2272 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2273 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2274 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2275 will cause it to terminate.
2276
2277 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2278 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2279 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2280 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2281 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2282 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2283 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2284 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2285 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2286 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2287
2288 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2289 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2290 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2291
2292 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2293 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2294
2295 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2296 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2297
2298 @table @code
2299 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2300 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2301 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2302 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2303 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2304
2305 @table @code
2306 @item parent
2307 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2308 unimpeded. This is the default.
2309
2310 @item child
2311 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2312 unimpeded.
2313
2314 @item ask
2315 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2316 @end table
2317
2318 @item show follow-fork-mode
2319 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2320 @end table
2321
2322 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2323 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2324 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2325 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2326 the child process's @code{main}.
2327
2328 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2329 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2330
2331 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2332 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2333 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2334 argument.
2335
2336 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2337 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2338 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2339
2340 @node Stopping
2341 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2342
2343 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2344 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2345 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2346
2347 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2348 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2349 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2350 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2351 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2352 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2353 explicitly request this information at any time.
2354
2355 @table @code
2356 @kindex info program
2357 @item info program
2358 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2359 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2360 @end table
2361
2362 @menu
2363 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2364 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2365 * Signals:: Signals
2366 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2367 @end menu
2368
2369 @node Breakpoints
2370 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2371
2372 @cindex breakpoints
2373 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2374 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2375 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2376 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2377 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2378 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2379 program.
2380
2381 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2382 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2383 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2384 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2385 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2386 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2387
2388 @cindex watchpoints
2389 @cindex memory tracing
2390 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2391 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2392 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2393 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2394 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2395 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2396 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2397 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2398
2399 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2400 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2401 Automatic display}.
2402
2403 @cindex catchpoints
2404 @cindex breakpoint on events
2405 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2406 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2407 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2408 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2409 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2410 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2411 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2412
2413 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2414 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2415 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2416 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2417 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2418 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2419 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2420 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2421 enable it again.
2422
2423 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2424 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2425 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2426 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2427 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2428 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2429 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2430
2431 @menu
2432 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2433 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2434 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2435 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2436 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2437 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2438 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2439 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2440 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2441 @end menu
2442
2443 @node Set Breaks
2444 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2445
2446 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2447 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2448 @c
2449 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2450
2451 @kindex break
2452 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2453 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2454 @cindex latest breakpoint
2455 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2456 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2457 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2458 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2459 convenience variables.
2460
2461 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2462
2463 @table @code
2464 @item break @var{function}
2465 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2466 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2467 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2468 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2469
2470 @item break +@var{offset}
2471 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2472 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2473 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2474 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2475
2476 @item break @var{linenum}
2477 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2478 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2479 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2480 code on that line.
2481
2482 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2483 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2484
2485 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2486 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2487 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2488 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2489 functions.
2490
2491 @item break *@var{address}
2492 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2493 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2494 information or source files.
2495
2496 @item break
2497 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2498 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2499 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2500 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2501 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2502 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2503 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2504 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2505 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2506 inside loops.
2507
2508 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2509 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2510 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2511 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2512 existed when your program stopped.
2513
2514 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2515 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2516 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2517 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2518 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2519 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2520 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2521
2522 @kindex tbreak
2523 @item tbreak @var{args}
2524 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2525 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2526 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2527 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2528
2529 @kindex hbreak
2530 @item hbreak @var{args}
2531 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2532 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2533 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2534 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2535 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2536 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2537 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2538 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2539 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2540 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2541 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2542 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2543 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2544 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2545 @xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2546
2547
2548 @kindex thbreak
2549 @item thbreak @var{args}
2550 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2551 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2552 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2553 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2554 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2555 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2556 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2557 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2558
2559 @kindex rbreak
2560 @cindex regular expression
2561 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2562 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2563 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2564 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2565 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2566 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2567 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2568
2569 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2570 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2571 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2572 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2573 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2574 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2575
2576 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2577 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2578 classes.
2579
2580 @kindex info breakpoints
2581 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2582 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2583 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2584 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2585 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2586 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2587
2588 @table @emph
2589 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2590 @item Type
2591 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2592 @item Disposition
2593 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2594 @item Enabled or Disabled
2595 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2596 that are not enabled.
2597 @item Address
2598 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2599 @item What
2600 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2601 line number.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @noindent
2605 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2606 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2607 are listed after that.
2608
2609 @noindent
2610 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2611 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2612 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2613 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2614 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2615
2616 @noindent
2617 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2618 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2619 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2620 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2621 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2622 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2623 @end table
2624
2625 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2626 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2627 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2628 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2629
2630 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2631 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2632 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2633 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2634 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2635 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2636 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2637 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2638
2639
2640 @node Set Watchpoints
2641 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2642
2643 @cindex setting watchpoints
2644 @cindex software watchpoints
2645 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2646 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2647 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2648 this may happen.
2649
2650 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2651 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2652 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2653 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2654 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2655 culprit.)
2656
2657 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2658 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2659 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2660 program.
2661
2662 @table @code
2663 @kindex watch
2664 @item watch @var{expr}
2665 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2666 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2667
2668 @kindex rwatch
2669 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2670 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2671
2672 @kindex awatch
2673 @item awatch @var{expr}
2674 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2675 by the program.
2676
2677 @kindex info watchpoints
2678 @item info watchpoints
2679 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2680 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2681 @end table
2682
2683 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2684 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2685 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2686 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2687 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2688 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2689
2690 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2691
2692 @smallexample
2693 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2694 @end smallexample
2695
2696 @noindent
2697 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2698
2699 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2700 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2701 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2702 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2703 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2704 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2705 will print a message like this:
2706
2707 @smallexample
2708 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2709 @end smallexample
2710
2711 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2712 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2713 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2714 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2715 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2716 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2717 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2718 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2719
2720 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2721 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2722 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2723 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2724 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2725 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2726
2727 @smallexample
2728 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2729 @end smallexample
2730
2731 @noindent
2732 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2733
2734 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2735 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2736 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2737 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2738 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2739 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2740 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2741 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2742 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2743 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2744
2745 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2746 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2747 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2748
2749 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2750 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2751 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2752 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2753 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2754 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2755 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2756 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2757 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2758
2759 @quotation
2760 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2761 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2762 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2763 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2764 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2765 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2766 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2767 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2768 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2769 the expression.
2770
2771 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2772 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2773 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2774 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2775 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2776 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2777 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2778 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2779 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2780 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2781 @end quotation
2782
2783 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2784
2785 @node Set Catchpoints
2786 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2787 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2788 @cindex exception handlers
2789 @cindex event handling
2790
2791 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2792 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2793 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2794
2795 @table @code
2796 @kindex catch
2797 @item catch @var{event}
2798 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2799 @table @code
2800 @item throw
2801 @kindex catch throw
2802 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2803
2804 @item catch
2805 @kindex catch catch
2806 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2807
2808 @item exec
2809 @kindex catch exec
2810 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2811
2812 @item fork
2813 @kindex catch fork
2814 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2815
2816 @item vfork
2817 @kindex catch vfork
2818 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2819
2820 @item load
2821 @itemx load @var{libname}
2822 @kindex catch load
2823 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2824 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2825
2826 @item unload
2827 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2828 @kindex catch unload
2829 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2830 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2831 @end table
2832
2833 @item tcatch @var{event}
2834 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2835 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2836
2837 @end table
2838
2839 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2840
2841 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2842 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2843
2844 @itemize @bullet
2845 @item
2846 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2847 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2848 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2849 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2850 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2851 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2852 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2853 disabled within interactive calls.
2854
2855 @item
2856 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2857
2858 @item
2859 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2860 @end itemize
2861
2862 @cindex raise exceptions
2863 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2864 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2865 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2866 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2867 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2868 out where the exception was raised.
2869
2870 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2871 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2872 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2873 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2874
2875 @smallexample
2876 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2877 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2878 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2879 @end smallexample
2880
2881 @noindent
2882 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2883 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2884 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2885
2886 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2887 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2888 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2889 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2890 raised.
2891
2892
2893 @node Delete Breaks
2894 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2895
2896 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2897 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2898 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2899 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2900 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2901 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2902
2903 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2904 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2905 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2906 their breakpoint numbers.
2907
2908 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2909 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2910 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2911
2912 @table @code
2913 @kindex clear
2914 @item clear
2915 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2916 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2917 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2918 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2919
2920 @item clear @var{function}
2921 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2922 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2923
2924 @item clear @var{linenum}
2925 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2926 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2927
2928 @cindex delete breakpoints
2929 @kindex delete
2930 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2931 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2932 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2933 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2934 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2935 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2936 @end table
2937
2938 @node Disabling
2939 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2940
2941 @kindex disable breakpoints
2942 @kindex enable breakpoints
2943 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2944 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2945 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2946 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2947
2948 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2949 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2950 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2951 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2952 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2953
2954 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2955 states of enablement:
2956
2957 @itemize @bullet
2958 @item
2959 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2960 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2961 @item
2962 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2963 @item
2964 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2965 disabled.
2966 @item
2967 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2968 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2969 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2970 @end itemize
2971
2972 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2973 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2974
2975 @table @code
2976 @kindex disable breakpoints
2977 @kindex disable
2978 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2979 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2980 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2981 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2982 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2983 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2984 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2985
2986 @kindex enable breakpoints
2987 @kindex enable
2988 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2989 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2990 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2991
2992 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2993 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2994 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2995
2996 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2997 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2998 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2999 @end table
3000
3001 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3002 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3003 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3004 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3005 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3006 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3007 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3008 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3009 stepping}.)
3010
3011 @node Conditions
3012 @subsection Break conditions
3013 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3014 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3015
3016 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3017 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3018 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3019 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3020 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3021 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3022 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3023 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3024
3025 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3026 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3027 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3028 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3029 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3030
3031 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3032 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3033 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3034 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3035 one.
3036
3037 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3038 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3039 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3040 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3041 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3042 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3043 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3044 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3045 conditions for the
3046 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3047 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3048
3049 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3050 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3051 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3052 with the @code{condition} command.
3053
3054 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3055 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3056 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3057 catchpoint.
3058
3059 @table @code
3060 @kindex condition
3061 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3062 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3063 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3064 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3065 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3066 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3067 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3068 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3069 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3070 prints an error message:
3071
3072 @smallexample
3073 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3074 @end smallexample
3075
3076 @noindent
3077 @value{GDBN} does
3078 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3079 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3080 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3081
3082 @item condition @var{bnum}
3083 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3084 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3085 @end table
3086
3087 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3088 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3089 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3090 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3091 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3092 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3093 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3094 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3095 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3096 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3097 your program reaches it.
3098
3099 @table @code
3100 @kindex ignore
3101 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3102 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3103 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3104 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3105 takes no action.
3106
3107 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3108 a count of zero.
3109
3110 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3111 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3112 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3113 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3114
3115 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3116 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3117 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3118
3119 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3120 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3121 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3122 variables}.
3123 @end table
3124
3125 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3126
3127
3128 @node Break Commands
3129 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3130
3131 @cindex breakpoint commands
3132 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3133 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3134 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3135 enable other breakpoints.
3136
3137 @table @code
3138 @kindex commands
3139 @kindex end
3140 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3141 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3142 @itemx end
3143 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3144 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3145 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3146
3147 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3148 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3149
3150 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3151 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3152 recently encountered).
3153 @end table
3154
3155 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3156 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3157
3158 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3159 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3160 that resumes execution.
3161
3162 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3163 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3164 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3165 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3166 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3167
3168 @kindex silent
3169 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3170 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3171 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3172 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3173 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3174 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3175
3176 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3177 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3178 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3179
3180 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3181 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3182
3183 @smallexample
3184 break foo if x>0
3185 commands
3186 silent
3187 printf "x is %d\n",x
3188 cont
3189 end
3190 @end smallexample
3191
3192 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3193 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3194 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3195 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3196 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3197 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3198 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3199
3200 @smallexample
3201 break 403
3202 commands
3203 silent
3204 set x = y + 4
3205 cont
3206 end
3207 @end smallexample
3208
3209 @node Breakpoint Menus
3210 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3211 @cindex overloading
3212 @cindex symbol overloading
3213
3214 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3215 single function name
3216 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3217 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3218 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3219 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3220 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3221 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3222 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3223 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3224 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3225 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3226 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3227 breakpoints.
3228
3229 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3230 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3231 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3232
3233 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3234 @smallexample
3235 @group
3236 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3237 [0] cancel
3238 [1] all
3239 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3240 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3241 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3242 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3243 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3244 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3245 > 2 4 6
3246 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3247 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3248 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3249 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3250 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3251 breakpoints.
3252 (@value{GDBP})
3253 @end group
3254 @end smallexample
3255
3256 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3257 @node Error in Breakpoints
3258 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3259 @c
3260 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3261 @c
3262 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3263 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3264 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3265 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3266
3267 @smallexample
3268 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3269 The same program may be running in another process.
3270 @end smallexample
3271
3272 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3273
3274 @enumerate
3275 @item
3276 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3277
3278 @item
3279 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3280 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3281 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3282 Then start your program again.
3283
3284 @item
3285 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3286 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3287 to nonsharable executables.
3288 @end enumerate
3289 @c @end ifclear
3290
3291 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3292 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3293
3294 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3295 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3296 @smallexample
3297 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3298 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3299 @end smallexample
3300
3301 @noindent
3302 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3303 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3304 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3305
3306 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3307 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3308
3309
3310 @node Continuing and Stepping
3311 @section Continuing and stepping
3312
3313 @cindex stepping
3314 @cindex continuing
3315 @cindex resuming execution
3316 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3317 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3318 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3319 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3320 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3321 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3322 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3323 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3324
3325 @table @code
3326 @kindex continue
3327 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3328 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3329 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3330 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3331 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3332 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3333 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3334 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3335 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3336 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3337
3338 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3339 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3340 @code{continue} is ignored.
3341
3342 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3343 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3344 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3345 @code{continue}.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3349 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3350 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3351 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3352
3353 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3354 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3355 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3356 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3357 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3358 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3359
3360 @table @code
3361 @kindex step
3362 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3363 @item step
3364 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3365 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3366 abbreviated @code{s}.
3367
3368 @quotation
3369 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3370 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3371 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3372 @c distinction here.
3373 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3374 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3375 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3376 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3377 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3378 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3379 below.
3380 @end quotation
3381
3382 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3383 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3384 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3385 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3386 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3387 called within the line.
3388
3389 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3390 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3391 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3392 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3393 was any debugging information about the routine.
3394
3395 @item step @var{count}
3396 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3397 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3398 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3399
3400 @kindex next
3401 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3402 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3403 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3404 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3405 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3406 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3407 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3408 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3409
3410 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3411
3412
3413 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3414 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3415 @c
3416 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3417 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3418 @c function are executed without stopping.
3419
3420 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3421 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3422 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3423
3424 @kindex set step-mode
3425 @item set step-mode
3426 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3427 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3428 @itemx set step-mode on
3429 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3430 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3431 information rather than stepping over it.
3432
3433 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3434 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3435 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3436
3437 @item set step-mode off
3438 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3439 debug information. This is the default.
3440
3441 @kindex finish
3442 @item finish
3443 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3444 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3445
3446 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3447 ,Returning from a function}).
3448
3449 @kindex until
3450 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3451 @item until
3452 @itemx u
3453 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3454 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3455 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3456 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3457 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3458 than the address of the jump.
3459
3460 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3461 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3462 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3463 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3464 through the next iteration.
3465
3466 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3467 stack frame.
3468
3469 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3470 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3471 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3472 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3473 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3474
3475 @smallexample
3476 (@value{GDBP}) f
3477 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3478 206 expand_input();
3479 (@value{GDBP}) until
3480 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3481 @end smallexample
3482
3483 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3484 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3485 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3486 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3487 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3488 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3489 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3490
3491 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3492 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3493 argument.
3494
3495 @item until @var{location}
3496 @itemx u @var{location}
3497 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3498 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3499 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3500 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3501 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3502 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3503 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3504 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3505 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3506 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3507 invocations have returned.
3508
3509 @smallexample
3510 94 int factorial (int value)
3511 95 @{
3512 96 if (value > 1) @{
3513 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
3514 98 @}
3515 99 return (value);
3516 100 @}
3517 @end smallexample
3518
3519
3520 @kindex advance @var{location}
3521 @itemx advance @var{location}
3522 Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3523 required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3524 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3525 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3526 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3527 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3528
3529
3530 @kindex stepi
3531 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3532 @item stepi
3533 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3534 @itemx si
3535 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3536
3537 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3538 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3539 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3540 Display,, Automatic display}.
3541
3542 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3543
3544 @need 750
3545 @kindex nexti
3546 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3547 @item nexti
3548 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3549 @itemx ni
3550 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3551 proceed until the function returns.
3552
3553 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3554 @end table
3555
3556 @node Signals
3557 @section Signals
3558 @cindex signals
3559
3560 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3561 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3562 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3563 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3564 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3565 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3566 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3567 requested an alarm).
3568
3569 @cindex fatal signals
3570 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3571 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3572 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3573 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3574 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3575 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3576
3577 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3578 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3579 signal.
3580
3581 @cindex handling signals
3582 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3583 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3584 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3585 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3586 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3587
3588 @table @code
3589 @kindex info signals
3590 @item info signals
3591 @itemx info handle
3592 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3593 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3594 the defined types of signals.
3595
3596 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3597
3598 @kindex handle
3599 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3600 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3601 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3602 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3603 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3604 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3605 @end table
3606
3607 @c @group
3608 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3609 Their full names are:
3610
3611 @table @code
3612 @item nostop
3613 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3614 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3615
3616 @item stop
3617 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3618 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3619
3620 @item print
3621 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3622
3623 @item noprint
3624 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3625 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3626
3627 @item pass
3628 @itemx noignore
3629 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3630 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3631 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3632
3633 @item nopass
3634 @itemx ignore
3635 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3636 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3637 @end table
3638 @c @end group
3639
3640 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3641 program until you
3642 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3643 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3644 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3645 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3646 program sees that signal when you continue.
3647
3648 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3649 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3650 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3651 erroneous signals.
3652
3653 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3654 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3655 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3656 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3657 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3658 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3659 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3660 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3661 program a signal}.
3662
3663 @node Thread Stops
3664 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3665
3666 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3667 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3668 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3669
3670 @table @code
3671 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3672 @cindex thread breakpoints
3673 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3674 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3675 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3676 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3677 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3678
3679 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3680 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3681 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3682 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3683 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3684
3685 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3686 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3687 program.
3688
3689 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3690 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3691 breakpoint condition, like this:
3692
3693 @smallexample
3694 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3695 @end smallexample
3696
3697 @end table
3698
3699 @cindex stopped threads
3700 @cindex threads, stopped
3701 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3702 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3703 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3704 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3705 underfoot.
3706
3707 @cindex continuing threads
3708 @cindex threads, continuing
3709 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3710 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3711 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3712
3713 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3714 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3715 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3716 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3717 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3718 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3719 stops.
3720
3721 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3722 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3723 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3724 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3725
3726 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3727 thread to run.
3728
3729 @table @code
3730 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3731 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3732 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3733 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3734 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3735 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3736 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3737 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3738 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3739 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3740 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3741 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3742
3743 @item show scheduler-locking
3744 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3745 @end table
3746
3747
3748 @node Stack
3749 @chapter Examining the Stack
3750
3751 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3752 stopped and how it got there.
3753
3754 @cindex call stack
3755 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3756 is generated.
3757 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3758 the arguments of the call,
3759 and the local variables of the function being called.
3760 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3761 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3762 stack}.
3763
3764 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3765 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3766
3767 @cindex selected frame
3768 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3769 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3770 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3771 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3772 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3773 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3774
3775 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3776 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3777 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3778
3779 @menu
3780 * Frames:: Stack frames
3781 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3782 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3783 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3784
3785 @end menu
3786
3787 @node Frames
3788 @section Stack frames
3789
3790 @cindex frame, definition
3791 @cindex stack frame
3792 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3793 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3794 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3795 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3796 which the function is executing.
3797
3798 @cindex initial frame
3799 @cindex outermost frame
3800 @cindex innermost frame
3801 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3802 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3803 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3804 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3805 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3806 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3807 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3808 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3809
3810 @cindex frame pointer
3811 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3812 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3813 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3814 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3815 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3816 going on in that frame.
3817
3818 @cindex frame number
3819 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3820 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3821 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3822 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3823 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3824
3825 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3826 @c underflow problems.
3827 @cindex frameless execution
3828 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3829 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3830 @smallexample
3831 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3832 @end smallexample
3833 generates functions without a frame.)
3834 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3835 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3836 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3837 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3838 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3839 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3840 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3841
3842 @table @code
3843 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3844 @cindex current stack frame
3845 @item frame @var{args}
3846 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3847 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3848 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3849 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3850
3851 @kindex select-frame
3852 @cindex selecting frame silently
3853 @item select-frame
3854 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3855 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3856 @code{frame}.
3857 @end table
3858
3859 @node Backtrace
3860 @section Backtraces
3861
3862 @cindex backtraces
3863 @cindex tracebacks
3864 @cindex stack traces
3865 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3866 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3867 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3868 stack.
3869
3870 @table @code
3871 @kindex backtrace
3872 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3873 @item backtrace
3874 @itemx bt
3875 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3876 frames in the stack.
3877
3878 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3879 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3880
3881 @item backtrace @var{n}
3882 @itemx bt @var{n}
3883 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3884
3885 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3886 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3887 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3888 @end table
3889
3890 @kindex where
3891 @kindex info stack
3892 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3893 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3894 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3895
3896 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3897 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3898 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3899 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3900 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3901 line number.
3902
3903 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3904 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3905
3906 @smallexample
3907 @group
3908 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3909 at builtin.c:993
3910 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3911 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3912 at macro.c:71
3913 (More stack frames follow...)
3914 @end group
3915 @end smallexample
3916
3917 @noindent
3918 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3919 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3920 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3921
3922 @kindex set backtrace-below-main
3923 @kindex show backtrace-below-main
3924
3925 Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3926 and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3927 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3928 the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3929 uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3930 change this behavior.
3931
3932 @table @code
3933 @item set backtrace-below-main off
3934 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3935 default.
3936
3937 @item set backtrace-below-main
3938 @itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3939 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3940
3941 @item show backtrace-below-main
3942 Display the current backtrace policy.
3943 @end table
3944
3945 @node Selection
3946 @section Selecting a frame
3947
3948 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3949 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3950 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3951 of the stack frame just selected.
3952
3953 @table @code
3954 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3955 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3956 @item frame @var{n}
3957 @itemx f @var{n}
3958 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3959 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3960 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3961 @code{main}.
3962
3963 @item frame @var{addr}
3964 @itemx f @var{addr}
3965 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3966 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3967 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3968 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3969 switches between them.
3970
3971 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3972 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3973
3974 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3975 pointer and a program counter.
3976
3977 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3978 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3979 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3980 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3981 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3982
3983 @kindex up
3984 @item up @var{n}
3985 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3986 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3987 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3988
3989 @kindex down
3990 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3991 @item down @var{n}
3992 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3993 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3994 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3995 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3996 @end table
3997
3998 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3999 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4000 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4001 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4002
4003 @need 1000
4004 For example:
4005
4006 @smallexample
4007 @group
4008 (@value{GDBP}) up
4009 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4010 at env.c:10
4011 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4012 @end group
4013 @end smallexample
4014
4015 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4016 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4017 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4018 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4019 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4020 for details.
4021
4022 @table @code
4023 @kindex down-silently
4024 @kindex up-silently
4025 @item up-silently @var{n}
4026 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4027 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4028 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4029 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4030 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4031 distracting.
4032 @end table
4033
4034 @node Frame Info
4035 @section Information about a frame
4036
4037 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4038 stack frame.
4039
4040 @table @code
4041 @item frame
4042 @itemx f
4043 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4044 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4045 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4046 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4047 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4048
4049 @kindex info frame
4050 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4051 @item info frame
4052 @itemx info f
4053 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4054 including:
4055
4056 @itemize @bullet
4057 @item
4058 the address of the frame
4059 @item
4060 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4061 @item
4062 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4063 @item
4064 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4065 @item
4066 the address of the frame's arguments
4067 @item
4068 the address of the frame's local variables
4069 @item
4070 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4071 @item
4072 which registers were saved in the frame
4073 @end itemize
4074
4075 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4076 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4077 the usual conventions.
4078
4079 @item info frame @var{addr}
4080 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4081 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4082 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4083 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4084 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4085 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4086
4087 @kindex info args
4088 @item info args
4089 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4090
4091 @item info locals
4092 @kindex info locals
4093 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4094 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4095 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4096
4097 @kindex info catch
4098 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4099 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4100 @item info catch
4101 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4102 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4103 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4104 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4105 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4106
4107 @end table
4108
4109
4110 @node Source
4111 @chapter Examining Source Files
4112
4113 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4114 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4115 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4116 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4117 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4118 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4119 source files by explicit command.
4120
4121 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4122 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4123 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4124
4125 @menu
4126 * List:: Printing source lines
4127 * Edit:: Editing source files
4128 * Search:: Searching source files
4129 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4130 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4131 @end menu
4132
4133 @node List
4134 @section Printing source lines
4135
4136 @kindex list
4137 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4138 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4139 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4140 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4141
4142 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4143
4144 @table @code
4145 @item list @var{linenum}
4146 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4147 current source file.
4148
4149 @item list @var{function}
4150 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4151 @var{function}.
4152
4153 @item list
4154 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4155 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4156 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4157 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4158 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4159
4160 @item list -
4161 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4162 @end table
4163
4164 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4165 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4166
4167 @table @code
4168 @kindex set listsize
4169 @item set listsize @var{count}
4170 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4171 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4172
4173 @kindex show listsize
4174 @item show listsize
4175 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4176 @end table
4177
4178 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4179 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4180 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4181 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4182 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4183
4184 @cindex linespec
4185 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4186 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4187 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4188 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4189
4190 @table @code
4191 @item list @var{linespec}
4192 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4193
4194 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4195 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4196 linespecs.
4197
4198 @item list ,@var{last}
4199 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4200
4201 @item list @var{first},
4202 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4203
4204 @item list +
4205 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4206
4207 @item list -
4208 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4209
4210 @item list
4211 As described in the preceding table.
4212 @end table
4213
4214 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4215 kinds of linespec.
4216
4217 @table @code
4218 @item @var{number}
4219 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4220 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4221 the same source file as the first linespec.
4222
4223 @item +@var{offset}
4224 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4225 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4226 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4227 first linespec.
4228
4229 @item -@var{offset}
4230 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4231
4232 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4233 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4234
4235 @item @var{function}
4236 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4237 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4238
4239 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4240 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4241 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4242 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4243 identically named functions in different source files.
4244
4245 @item *@var{address}
4246 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4247 @var{address} may be any expression.
4248 @end table
4249
4250 @node Edit
4251 @section Editing source files
4252 @cindex editing source files
4253
4254 @kindex edit
4255 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4256 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4257 The editing program of your choice
4258 is invoked with the current line set to
4259 the active line in the program.
4260 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4261 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4262
4263 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4264
4265 @table @code
4266 @item edit
4267 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4268
4269 @item edit @var{number}
4270 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4271
4272 @item edit @var{function}
4273 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4274
4275 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4276 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4277
4278 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4279 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4280 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4281 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4282 identically named functions in different source files.
4283
4284 @item edit *@var{address}
4285 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4286 @var{address} may be any expression.
4287 @end table
4288
4289 @subsection Choosing your editor
4290 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4291 @footnote{
4292 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4293 following command-line syntax:
4294 @smallexample
4295 ex +@var{number} file
4296 @end smallexample
4297 The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4298 the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4299 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4300 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4301 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4302 @smallexample
4303 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4304 export EDITOR
4305 gdb ...
4306 @end smallexample
4307 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4308 @smallexample
4309 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4310 gdb ...
4311 @end smallexample
4312
4313 @node Search
4314 @section Searching source files
4315 @cindex searching
4316 @kindex reverse-search
4317
4318 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4319 regular expression.
4320
4321 @table @code
4322 @kindex search
4323 @kindex forward-search
4324 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4325 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4326 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4327 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4328 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4329 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4330 @code{fo}.
4331
4332 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4333 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4334 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4335 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4336 this command as @code{rev}.
4337 @end table
4338
4339 @node Source Path
4340 @section Specifying source directories
4341
4342 @cindex source path
4343 @cindex directories for source files
4344 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4345 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4346 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4347 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4348 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4349 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4350 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4351 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4352 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4353 path.
4354
4355 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4356 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4357 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4358 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4359 last resort.
4360
4361 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4362 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4363 each line is in the file.
4364
4365 @kindex directory
4366 @kindex dir
4367 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4368 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4369 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4370
4371 @table @code
4372 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4373 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4374 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4375 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4376 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4377 part of absolute file names) or
4378 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4379 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4380
4381 @kindex cdir
4382 @kindex cwd
4383 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4384 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4385 @cindex compilation directory
4386 @cindex current directory
4387 @cindex working directory
4388 @cindex directory, current
4389 @cindex directory, compilation
4390 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4391 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4392 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4393 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4394 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4395 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4396
4397 @item directory
4398 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4399
4400 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4401 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4402
4403 @item show directories
4404 @kindex show directories
4405 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4406 @end table
4407
4408 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4409 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4410 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4411
4412 @enumerate
4413 @item
4414 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4415
4416 @item
4417 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4418 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4419 directories in one command.
4420 @end enumerate
4421
4422 @node Machine Code
4423 @section Source and machine code
4424
4425 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4426 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4427 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4428 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4429 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4430 well as hex.
4431
4432 @table @code
4433 @kindex info line
4434 @item info line @var{linespec}
4435 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4436 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4437 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4438 source lines}).
4439 @end table
4440
4441 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4442 the object code for the first line of function
4443 @code{m4_changequote}:
4444
4445 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4446 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4447 @smallexample
4448 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4449 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4450 @end smallexample
4451
4452 @noindent
4453 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4454 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4455 @smallexample
4456 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4457 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4458 @end smallexample
4459
4460 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4461 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4462 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4463 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4464 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4465 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4466 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4467 variables}).
4468
4469 @table @code
4470 @kindex disassemble
4471 @cindex assembly instructions
4472 @cindex instructions, assembly
4473 @cindex machine instructions
4474 @cindex listing machine instructions
4475 @item disassemble
4476 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4477 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4478 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4479 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4480 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4481 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4482 @end table
4483
4484 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4485 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4486
4487 @smallexample
4488 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4489 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4490 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4491 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4492 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4493 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4494 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4495 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4496 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4497 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4498 End of assembler dump.
4499 @end smallexample
4500
4501 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4502 mnemonics or other syntax.
4503
4504 @table @code
4505 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4506 @cindex assembly instructions
4507 @cindex instructions, assembly
4508 @cindex machine instructions
4509 @cindex listing machine instructions
4510 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4511 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4512 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4513 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4514 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4515
4516 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4517 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4518 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4519 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4520 @end table
4521
4522
4523 @node Data
4524 @chapter Examining Data
4525
4526 @cindex printing data
4527 @cindex examining data
4528 @kindex print
4529 @kindex inspect
4530 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4531 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4532 @c different window or something like that.
4533 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4534 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4535 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4536 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4537 Different Languages}).
4538
4539 @table @code
4540 @item print @var{expr}
4541 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4542 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4543 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4544 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4545 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4546 formats}.
4547
4548 @item print
4549 @itemx print /@var{f}
4550 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4551 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4552 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4553 @end table
4554
4555 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4556 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4557 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4558
4559 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4560 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4561 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4562 Table}.
4563
4564 @menu
4565 * Expressions:: Expressions
4566 * Variables:: Program variables
4567 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4568 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4569 * Memory:: Examining memory
4570 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4571 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4572 * Value History:: Value history
4573 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4574 * Registers:: Registers
4575 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4576 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
4577 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4578 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4579 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4580 character set than GDB does
4581 @end menu
4582
4583 @node Expressions
4584 @section Expressions
4585
4586 @cindex expressions
4587 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4588 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4589 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4590 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4591 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4592 you compiled your program to include this information; see
4593 @ref{Compilation}.
4594
4595 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4596 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4597 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4598 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4599
4600 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4601 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4602 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4603 languages.
4604
4605 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4606 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4607
4608 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4609 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4610 at that address in memory.
4611 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4612
4613 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4614 to programming languages:
4615
4616 @table @code
4617 @item @@
4618 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4619 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4620
4621 @item ::
4622 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4623 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4624
4625 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4626 @cindex type casting memory
4627 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4628 @cindex casts, to view memory
4629 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4630 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4631 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4632 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4633 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4634 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4635 @end table
4636
4637 @node Variables
4638 @section Program variables
4639
4640 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4641 in your program.
4642
4643 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4644 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4645
4646 @itemize @bullet
4647 @item
4648 global (or file-static)
4649 @end itemize
4650
4651 @noindent or
4652
4653 @itemize @bullet
4654 @item
4655 visible according to the scope rules of the
4656 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4657 @end itemize
4658
4659 @noindent This means that in the function
4660
4661 @smallexample
4662 foo (a)
4663 int a;
4664 @{
4665 bar (a);
4666 @{
4667 int b = test ();
4668 bar (b);
4669 @}
4670 @}
4671 @end smallexample
4672
4673 @noindent
4674 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4675 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4676 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4677 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4678
4679 @cindex variable name conflict
4680 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4681 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4682 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4683 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4684 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4685 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4686 using the colon-colon notation:
4687
4688 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4689 @iftex
4690 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4691 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4692 @end iftex
4693 @smallexample
4694 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4695 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4696 @end smallexample
4697
4698 @noindent
4699 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4700 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4701 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4702 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4703
4704 @smallexample
4705 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4706 @end smallexample
4707
4708 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4709 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4710 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4711 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4712 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4713 @c conflict?? --mew
4714
4715 @cindex wrong values
4716 @cindex variable values, wrong
4717 @quotation
4718 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4719 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4720 scope, and just before exit.
4721 @end quotation
4722 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4723 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4724 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4725 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4726 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4727 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4728 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4729 variable definitions may be gone.
4730
4731 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4732 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4733 when compiling.
4734
4735 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4736 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4737 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4738 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4739 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4740 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4741 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4742
4743 @smallexample
4744 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4745 @end smallexample
4746
4747 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4748 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4749 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4750 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4751 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4752 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4753 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4754 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
4755
4756
4757 @node Arrays
4758 @section Artificial arrays
4759
4760 @cindex artificial array
4761 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4762 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4763 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4764 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4765 program.
4766
4767 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4768 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4769 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4770 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4771 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4772 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4773 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4774 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4775 example. If a program says
4776
4777 @smallexample
4778 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4779 @end smallexample
4780
4781 @noindent
4782 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4783
4784 @smallexample
4785 p *array@@len
4786 @end smallexample
4787
4788 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4789 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4790 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4791 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4792 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4793
4794 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4795 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4796 The value need not be in memory:
4797 @smallexample
4798 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4799 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4800 @end smallexample
4801
4802 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4803 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4804 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4805 @smallexample
4806 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4807 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4808 @end smallexample
4809
4810 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4811 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4812 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4813 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4814 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4815 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4816 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4817 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4818 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4819 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4820
4821 @smallexample
4822 set $i = 0
4823 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4824 @key{RET}
4825 @key{RET}
4826 @dots{}
4827 @end smallexample
4828
4829 @node Output Formats
4830 @section Output formats
4831
4832 @cindex formatted output
4833 @cindex output formats
4834 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4835 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4836 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4837 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4838 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4839
4840 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4841 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4842 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4843 letters supported are:
4844
4845 @table @code
4846 @item x
4847 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4848 hexadecimal.
4849
4850 @item d
4851 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4852
4853 @item u
4854 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4855
4856 @item o
4857 Print as integer in octal.
4858
4859 @item t
4860 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4861 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4862 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4863 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4864
4865 @item a
4866 @cindex unknown address, locating
4867 @cindex locate address
4868 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4869 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4870 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4871
4872 @smallexample
4873 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4874 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4875 @end smallexample
4876
4877 @noindent
4878 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4879 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4880
4881 @item c
4882 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4883
4884 @item f
4885 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4886 using typical floating point syntax.
4887 @end table
4888
4889 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 p/x $pc
4893 @end smallexample
4894
4895 @noindent
4896 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4897 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4898
4899 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4900 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4901 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4902
4903 @node Memory
4904 @section Examining memory
4905
4906 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4907 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4908
4909 @cindex examining memory
4910 @table @code
4911 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4912 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4913 @itemx x @var{addr}
4914 @itemx x
4915 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4916 @end table
4917
4918 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4919 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4920 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4921 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4922 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4923
4924 @table @r
4925 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4926 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4927 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4928 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4929 @c 4.1.2.
4930
4931 @item @var{f}, the display format
4932 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4933 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4934 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4935 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4936
4937 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4938 The unit size is any of
4939
4940 @table @code
4941 @item b
4942 Bytes.
4943 @item h
4944 Halfwords (two bytes).
4945 @item w
4946 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4947 @item g
4948 Giant words (eight bytes).
4949 @end table
4950
4951 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4952 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4953 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4954
4955 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4956 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4957 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4958 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4959 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4960 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4961 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4962 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4963 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4964 a value from memory).
4965 @end table
4966
4967 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4968 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4969 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4970 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4971 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4972
4973 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4974 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4975 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4976 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4977 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4978
4979 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4980 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4981 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4982 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4983 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4984 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4985
4986 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4987 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4988 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4989 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4990 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4991 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4992 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4993
4994 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4995 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4996 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4997 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4998 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4999 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5000 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5001 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5002 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5003
5004 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5005 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5006 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5007
5008 @node Auto Display
5009 @section Automatic display
5010 @cindex automatic display
5011 @cindex display of expressions
5012
5013 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5014 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5015 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5016 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5017 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5018 The automatic display looks like this:
5019
5020 @smallexample
5021 2: foo = 38
5022 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5023 @end smallexample
5024
5025 @noindent
5026 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5027 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5028 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5029 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5030 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5031 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5032 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5033
5034 @table @code
5035 @kindex display
5036 @item display @var{expr}
5037 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5038 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5039
5040 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5041
5042 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5043 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5044 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5045 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5046 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5047
5048 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5049 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5050 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5051 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5052 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5053 @end table
5054
5055 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5056 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5057 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5058
5059 @table @code
5060 @kindex delete display
5061 @kindex undisplay
5062 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5063 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5064 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5065
5066 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5067 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5068
5069 @kindex disable display
5070 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5071 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5072 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5073 enabled again later.
5074
5075 @kindex enable display
5076 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5077 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5078 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5079
5080 @item display
5081 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5082 done when your program stops.
5083
5084 @kindex info display
5085 @item info display
5086 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5087 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5088 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5089 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5090 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5091 @end table
5092
5093 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5094 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5095 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5096 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5097 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5098 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5099 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5100 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5101 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5102 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5103
5104 @node Print Settings
5105 @section Print settings
5106
5107 @cindex format options
5108 @cindex print settings
5109 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5110 and symbols are printed.
5111
5112 @noindent
5113 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5114
5115 @table @code
5116 @kindex set print address
5117 @item set print address
5118 @itemx set print address on
5119 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5120 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5121 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5122 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5123 @code{set print address on}:
5124
5125 @smallexample
5126 @group
5127 (@value{GDBP}) f
5128 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5129 at input.c:530
5130 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5131 @end group
5132 @end smallexample
5133
5134 @item set print address off
5135 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5136 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5137
5138 @smallexample
5139 @group
5140 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5141 (@value{GDBP}) f
5142 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5143 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5144 @end group
5145 @end smallexample
5146
5147 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5148 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5149 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5150 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5151
5152 @kindex show print address
5153 @item show print address
5154 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5155 @end table
5156
5157 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5158 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5159 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5160 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5161 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5162 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5163 it prints a symbolic address:
5164
5165 @table @code
5166 @kindex set print symbol-filename
5167 @item set print symbol-filename on
5168 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5169 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5170
5171 @item set print symbol-filename off
5172 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5173 default.
5174
5175 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5176 @item show print symbol-filename
5177 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5178 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5179 @end table
5180
5181 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5182 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5183 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5184
5185 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5186 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5187
5188 @table @code
5189 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5190 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5191 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5192 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5193 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5194 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5195
5196 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5197 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5198 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5199 symbolic address.
5200 @end table
5201
5202 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5203 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5204 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5205 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5206 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5207 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5208 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5209 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5210
5211 @smallexample
5212 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5213 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5214 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5215 @end smallexample
5216
5217 @quotation
5218 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5219 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5220 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5221 @end quotation
5222
5223 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5224
5225 @table @code
5226 @kindex set print array
5227 @item set print array
5228 @itemx set print array on
5229 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5230 but uses more space. The default is off.
5231
5232 @item set print array off
5233 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5234
5235 @kindex show print array
5236 @item show print array
5237 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5238 arrays.
5239
5240 @kindex set print elements
5241 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5242 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5243 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5244 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5245 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5246 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5247 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5248
5249 @kindex show print elements
5250 @item show print elements
5251 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5252 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5253
5254 @kindex set print null-stop
5255 @item set print null-stop
5256 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5257 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5258 contain only short strings.
5259 The default is off.
5260
5261 @kindex set print pretty
5262 @item set print pretty on
5263 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5264 per line, like this:
5265
5266 @smallexample
5267 @group
5268 $1 = @{
5269 next = 0x0,
5270 flags = @{
5271 sweet = 1,
5272 sour = 1
5273 @},
5274 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5275 @}
5276 @end group
5277 @end smallexample
5278
5279 @item set print pretty off
5280 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5281
5282 @smallexample
5283 @group
5284 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5285 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5286 @end group
5287 @end smallexample
5288
5289 @noindent
5290 This is the default format.
5291
5292 @kindex show print pretty
5293 @item show print pretty
5294 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5295
5296 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5297 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5298 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5299 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5300 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5301 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5302 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5303
5304 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5305 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5306 international character sets, and is the default.
5307
5308 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5309 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5310 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5311
5312 @kindex set print union
5313 @item set print union on
5314 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5315 is the default setting.
5316
5317 @item set print union off
5318 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5319
5320 @kindex show print union
5321 @item show print union
5322 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5323 structures.
5324
5325 For example, given the declarations
5326
5327 @smallexample
5328 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5329 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5330 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5331 Bug_forms;
5332
5333 struct thing @{
5334 Species it;
5335 union @{
5336 Tree_forms tree;
5337 Bug_forms bug;
5338 @} form;
5339 @};
5340
5341 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5342 @end smallexample
5343
5344 @noindent
5345 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5346
5347 @smallexample
5348 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5349 @end smallexample
5350
5351 @noindent
5352 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5353
5354 @smallexample
5355 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5356 @end smallexample
5357 @end table
5358
5359 @need 1000
5360 @noindent
5361 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5362
5363 @table @code
5364 @cindex demangling
5365 @kindex set print demangle
5366 @item set print demangle
5367 @itemx set print demangle on
5368 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5369 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5370 linkage. The default is on.
5371
5372 @kindex show print demangle
5373 @item show print demangle
5374 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5375
5376 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5377 @item set print asm-demangle
5378 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5379 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5380 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5381 The default is off.
5382
5383 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5384 @item show print asm-demangle
5385 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5386 or demangled form.
5387
5388 @kindex set demangle-style
5389 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5390 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5391 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5392 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5393 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5394
5395 @table @code
5396 @item auto
5397 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5398
5399 @item gnu
5400 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5401 This is the default.
5402
5403 @item hp
5404 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5405
5406 @item lucid
5407 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5408
5409 @item arm
5410 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5411 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5412 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5413 require further enhancement to permit that.
5414
5415 @end table
5416 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5417
5418 @kindex show demangle-style
5419 @item show demangle-style
5420 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5421
5422 @kindex set print object
5423 @item set print object
5424 @itemx set print object on
5425 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5426 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5427 the virtual function table.
5428
5429 @item set print object off
5430 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5431 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5432
5433 @kindex show print object
5434 @item show print object
5435 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5436
5437 @kindex set print static-members
5438 @item set print static-members
5439 @itemx set print static-members on
5440 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5441
5442 @item set print static-members off
5443 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5444
5445 @kindex show print static-members
5446 @item show print static-members
5447 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5448
5449 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5450 @kindex set print vtbl
5451 @item set print vtbl
5452 @itemx set print vtbl on
5453 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5454 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5455 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5456
5457 @item set print vtbl off
5458 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5459
5460 @kindex show print vtbl
5461 @item show print vtbl
5462 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5463 @end table
5464
5465 @node Value History
5466 @section Value history
5467
5468 @cindex value history
5469 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5470 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5471 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5472 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5473 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5474 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5475 symbol table.
5476
5477 @cindex @code{$}
5478 @cindex @code{$$}
5479 @cindex history number
5480 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5481 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5482 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5483 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5484 history number.
5485
5486 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5487 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5488 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5489 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5490 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5491 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5492 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5493
5494 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5495 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5496
5497 @smallexample
5498 p *$
5499 @end smallexample
5500
5501 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5502 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5503
5504 @smallexample
5505 p *$.next
5506 @end smallexample
5507
5508 @noindent
5509 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5510 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5511
5512 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5513 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5514
5515 @smallexample
5516 print x
5517 set x=5
5518 @end smallexample
5519
5520 @noindent
5521 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5522 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5523
5524 @table @code
5525 @kindex show values
5526 @item show values
5527 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5528 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5529 values} does not change the history.
5530
5531 @item show values @var{n}
5532 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5533
5534 @item show values +
5535 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5536 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5537 @end table
5538
5539 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5540 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5541
5542 @node Convenience Vars
5543 @section Convenience variables
5544
5545 @cindex convenience variables
5546 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5547 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5548 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5549 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5550 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5551
5552 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5553 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5554 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5555 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5556 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5557
5558 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5559 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5560 For example:
5561
5562 @smallexample
5563 set $foo = *object_ptr
5564 @end smallexample
5565
5566 @noindent
5567 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5568 @code{object_ptr}.
5569
5570 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5571 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5572 value with another assignment at any time.
5573
5574 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5575 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5576 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5577 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5578
5579 @table @code
5580 @kindex show convenience
5581 @item show convenience
5582 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5583 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5584 @end table
5585
5586 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5587 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5588 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5589
5590 @smallexample
5591 set $i = 0
5592 print bar[$i++]->contents
5593 @end smallexample
5594
5595 @noindent
5596 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5597
5598 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5599 values likely to be useful.
5600
5601 @table @code
5602 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5603 @item $_
5604 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5605 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5606 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5607 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5608 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5609 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5610 to the type of @code{$__}.
5611
5612 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5613 @item $__
5614 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5615 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5616 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5617
5618 @item $_exitcode
5619 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5620 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5621 the program being debugged terminates.
5622 @end table
5623
5624 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5625 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5626 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5627
5628 @node Registers
5629 @section Registers
5630
5631 @cindex registers
5632 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5633 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5634 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5635 your machine.
5636
5637 @table @code
5638 @kindex info registers
5639 @item info registers
5640 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5641 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5642
5643 @kindex info all-registers
5644 @cindex floating point registers
5645 @item info all-registers
5646 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5647 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5648
5649 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5650 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5651 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5652 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5653 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5654 @end table
5655
5656 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5657 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5658 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5659 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5660 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5661 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5662 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5663 you could print the program counter in hex with
5664
5665 @smallexample
5666 p/x $pc
5667 @end smallexample
5668
5669 @noindent
5670 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5671
5672 @smallexample
5673 x/i $pc
5674 @end smallexample
5675
5676 @noindent
5677 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5678 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5679 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5680 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5681 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5682 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5683 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5684
5685 @smallexample
5686 set $sp += 4
5687 @end smallexample
5688
5689 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5690 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5691 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5692 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5693 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5694 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5695 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5696
5697 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5698 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5699 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5700 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5701 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5702 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5703 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5704
5705 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5706 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5707 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5708 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5709 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5710 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5711 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5712 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5713 prints the data in both formats.
5714
5715 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5716 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5717 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5718 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5719 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5720 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5721
5722 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5723 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5724 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5725 frame makes no difference.
5726
5727 @node Floating Point Hardware
5728 @section Floating point hardware
5729 @cindex floating point
5730
5731 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5732 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5733
5734 @table @code
5735 @kindex info float
5736 @item info float
5737 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5738 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5739 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5740 the ARM and x86 machines.
5741 @end table
5742
5743 @node Vector Unit
5744 @section Vector Unit
5745 @cindex vector unit
5746
5747 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5748 more information about the status of the vector unit.
5749
5750 @table @code
5751 @kindex info vector
5752 @item info vector
5753 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5754 layout vary depending on the hardware.
5755 @end table
5756
5757 @node Memory Region Attributes
5758 @section Memory region attributes
5759 @cindex memory region attributes
5760
5761 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5762 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5763 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5764 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5765
5766 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5767 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5768 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5769 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5770 all memory.
5771
5772 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5773 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5774
5775 @table @code
5776 @kindex mem
5777 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5778 Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5779 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5780 special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5781 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
5782
5783 @kindex delete mem
5784 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5785 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5786
5787 @kindex disable mem
5788 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5789 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5790 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5791 It may be enabled again later.
5792
5793 @kindex enable mem
5794 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5795 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5796
5797 @kindex info mem
5798 @item info mem
5799 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5800 for each region.
5801
5802 @table @emph
5803 @item Memory Region Number
5804 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5805 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5806 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5807
5808 @item Lo Address
5809 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5810
5811 @item Hi Address
5812 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5813
5814 @item Attributes
5815 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5816 @end table
5817 @end table
5818
5819
5820 @subsection Attributes
5821
5822 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5823 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5824 write accesses to a memory region.
5825
5826 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5827 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5828 etc. from accessing memory.
5829
5830 @table @code
5831 @item ro
5832 Memory is read only.
5833 @item wo
5834 Memory is write only.
5835 @item rw
5836 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5837 @end table
5838
5839 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5840 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5841 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5842 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5843 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5844
5845 @table @code
5846 @item 8
5847 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5848 @item 16
5849 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5850 @item 32
5851 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5852 @item 64
5853 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5854 @end table
5855
5856 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5857 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5858 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5859 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5860 @c
5861 @c @table @code
5862 @c @item hwbreak
5863 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5864 @c @item swbreak (default)
5865 @c @end table
5866
5867 @subsubsection Data Cache
5868 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5869 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5870 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5871 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5872 registers.
5873
5874 @table @code
5875 @item cache
5876 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5877 @item nocache
5878 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5879 @end table
5880
5881 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5882 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5883 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5884 @c
5885 @c @table @code
5886 @c @item verify
5887 @c @item noverify (default)
5888 @c @end table
5889
5890 @node Dump/Restore Files
5891 @section Copy between memory and a file
5892 @cindex dump/restore files
5893 @cindex append data to a file
5894 @cindex dump data to a file
5895 @cindex restore data from a file
5896
5897 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
5898 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
5899 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
5900 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
5901 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
5902 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
5903 files.
5904
5905 @table @code
5906
5907 @kindex dump
5908 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5909 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
5910 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
5911 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
5912
5913 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
5914 @table @code
5915 @item binary
5916 Raw binary form.
5917 @item ihex
5918 Intel hex format.
5919 @item srec
5920 Motorola S-record format.
5921 @item tekhex
5922 Tektronix Hex format.
5923 @end table
5924
5925 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
5926 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
5927 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
5928 form.
5929
5930 @kindex append
5931 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5932 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
5933 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
5934 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
5935 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
5936
5937 @kindex restore
5938 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
5939 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
5940 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
5941 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
5942 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
5943
5944 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5945 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5946 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5947 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5948 from that location.
5949
5950 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5951 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5952 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5953 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5954
5955 @end table
5956
5957 @node Character Sets
5958 @section Character Sets
5959 @cindex character sets
5960 @cindex charset
5961 @cindex translating between character sets
5962 @cindex host character set
5963 @cindex target character set
5964
5965 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5966 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5967 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5968 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5969 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5970 @dfn{target character set}.
5971
5972 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5973 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5974 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5975 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5976 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5977 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5978 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5979 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5980 character and string literals in expressions.
5981
5982 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5983 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5984 target-charset} command, described below.
5985
5986 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5987 support:
5988
5989 @table @code
5990 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
5991 @kindex set target-charset
5992 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5993 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
5994 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
5995 list the target character sets it supports.
5996 @end table
5997
5998 @table @code
5999 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6000 @kindex set host-charset
6001 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6002
6003 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6004 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6005 @code{set host-charset} command.
6006
6007 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6008 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6009 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6010 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6011 list the host character sets it supports.
6012
6013 @item set charset @var{charset}
6014 @kindex set charset
6015 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6016 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6017 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6018 for both host and target.
6019
6020
6021 @item show charset
6022 @kindex show charset
6023 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6024
6025 @itemx show host-charset
6026 @kindex show host-charset
6027 Show the name of the current host charset.
6028
6029 @itemx show target-charset
6030 @kindex show target-charset
6031 Show the name of the current target charset.
6032
6033 @end table
6034
6035 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6036 sets:
6037
6038 @table @code
6039
6040 @item ASCII
6041 @cindex ASCII character set
6042 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6043 character set.
6044
6045 @item ISO-8859-1
6046 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6047 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6048 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6049 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6050 this as its host character set.
6051
6052 @item EBCDIC-US
6053 @itemx IBM1047
6054 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6055 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6056 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6057 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6058 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6059
6060 @end table
6061
6062 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6063 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6064 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6065
6066 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6067 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6068 @file{charset-test.c}:
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 #include <stdio.h>
6072
6073 char ascii_hello[]
6074 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6075 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6076 char ibm1047_hello[]
6077 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6078 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6079
6080 main ()
6081 @{
6082 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6083 @}
6084 @end smallexample
6085
6086 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6087 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6088 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6089
6090 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6091
6092 @smallexample
6093 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6094 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6095 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6096 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6097 @dots{}
6098 (gdb)
6099 @end smallexample
6100
6101 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6102 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6103 strings:
6104
6105 @smallexample
6106 (gdb) show charset
6107 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6108 (gdb)
6109 @end smallexample
6110
6111 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6112 initial character set:
6113 @smallexample
6114 (gdb) set charset ASCII
6115 (gdb) show charset
6116 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
6117 (gdb)
6118 @end smallexample
6119
6120 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6121 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6122 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6123 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6124 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6125
6126 @smallexample
6127 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6128 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6129 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6130 $2 = 72 'H'
6131 (gdb)
6132 @end smallexample
6133
6134 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6135 literals you use in expressions:
6136
6137 @smallexample
6138 (gdb) print '+'
6139 $3 = 43 '+'
6140 (gdb)
6141 @end smallexample
6142
6143 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6144 character.
6145
6146 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6147 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6148 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6149
6150 @smallexample
6151 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6152 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6153 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6154 $5 = 200 '\310'
6155 (gdb)
6156 @end smallexample
6157
6158 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6159 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6160
6161 @smallexample
6162 (gdb) set target-charset
6163 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6164 (gdb) set target-charset
6165 @end smallexample
6166
6167 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6168 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6169 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6170 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6171 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6172
6173 @smallexample
6174 (gdb) set target-charset IBM1047
6175 (gdb) show charset
6176 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6177 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
6178 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6179 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6180 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6181 $7 = 72 '\110'
6182 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6183 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6184 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6185 $9 = 200 'H'
6186 (gdb)
6187 @end smallexample
6188
6189 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6190 string literals you use in expressions:
6191
6192 @smallexample
6193 (gdb) print '+'
6194 $10 = 78 '+'
6195 (gdb)
6196 @end smallexample
6197
6198 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6199 character.
6200
6201
6202 @node Macros
6203 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6204
6205 Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6206 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6207 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6208 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6209 where it was defined.
6210
6211 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6212 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6213 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6214 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6215
6216 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6217 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6218 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6219 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6220 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6221 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6222 see @ref{List}.
6223
6224 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6225 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6226 variable-arity macros.
6227
6228 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6229 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6230 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6231
6232 @table @code
6233
6234 @kindex macro expand
6235 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6236 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6237 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6238 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6239 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6240 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6241 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6242 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6243 it can be any string of tokens.
6244
6245 @kindex macro expand-once
6246 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6247 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6248 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6249 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6250 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6251 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6252 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6253 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6254 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6255 can be any string of tokens.
6256
6257 @kindex info macro
6258 @cindex macro definition, showing
6259 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6260 @item info macro @var{macro}
6261 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6262 source location where that definition was established.
6263
6264 @kindex macro define
6265 @cindex user-defined macros
6266 @cindex defining macros interactively
6267 @cindex macros, user-defined
6268 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6269 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6270 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6271 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6272 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6273 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6274 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6275 given in @var{arglist}.
6276
6277 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6278 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6279 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6280 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6281 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6282
6283 @kindex macro undef
6284 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6285 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6286 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6287 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6288 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6289 debugged.
6290
6291 @end table
6292
6293 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6294 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6295 show our source files:
6296
6297 @smallexample
6298 $ cat sample.c
6299 #include <stdio.h>
6300 #include "sample.h"
6301
6302 #define M 42
6303 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6304
6305 main ()
6306 @{
6307 #define N 28
6308 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6309 #undef N
6310 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6311 #define N 1729
6312 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6313 @}
6314 $ cat sample.h
6315 #define Q <
6316 $
6317 @end smallexample
6318
6319 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6320 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6321 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6322 information.
6323
6324 @smallexample
6325 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6326 $
6327 @end smallexample
6328
6329 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6330
6331 @smallexample
6332 $ gdb -nw sample
6333 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6334 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6335 GDB is free software, @dots{}
6336 (gdb)
6337 @end smallexample
6338
6339 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6340 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6341 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6342
6343 @smallexample
6344 (gdb) list main
6345 3
6346 4 #define M 42
6347 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6348 6
6349 7 main ()
6350 8 @{
6351 9 #define N 28
6352 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6353 11 #undef N
6354 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6355 (gdb) info macro ADD
6356 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6357 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6358 (gdb) info macro Q
6359 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6360 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6361 #define Q <
6362 (gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6363 expands to: (42 + 1)
6364 (gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6365 expands to: once (M + 1)
6366 (gdb)
6367 @end smallexample
6368
6369 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6370 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6371 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6372 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6373
6374 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6375 the source line of the current stack frame:
6376
6377 @smallexample
6378 (gdb) break main
6379 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6380 (gdb) run
6381 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6382
6383 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
6384 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6385 (gdb)
6386 @end smallexample
6387
6388 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6389
6390 @smallexample
6391 (gdb) info macro N
6392 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6393 #define N 28
6394 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6395 expands to: 28 < 42
6396 (gdb) print N Q M
6397 $1 = 1
6398 (gdb)
6399 @end smallexample
6400
6401 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6402 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6403 thereof) in force at each point:
6404
6405 @smallexample
6406 (gdb) next
6407 Hello, world!
6408 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6409 (gdb) info macro N
6410 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6411 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6412 (gdb) next
6413 We're so creative.
6414 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6415 (gdb) info macro N
6416 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6417 #define N 1729
6418 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6419 expands to: 1729 < 42
6420 (gdb) print N Q M
6421 $2 = 0
6422 (gdb)
6423 @end smallexample
6424
6425
6426 @node Tracepoints
6427 @chapter Tracepoints
6428 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6429 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6430
6431 @cindex tracepoints
6432 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6433 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6434 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6435 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6436 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6437 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6438 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6439
6440 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6441 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6442 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6443 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6444 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6445 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6446 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6447 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6448 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6449 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6450 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6451
6452 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
6453 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6454 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6455 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6456 tracepoints as of this writing.
6457
6458 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6459
6460 @menu
6461 * Set Tracepoints::
6462 * Analyze Collected Data::
6463 * Tracepoint Variables::
6464 @end menu
6465
6466 @node Set Tracepoints
6467 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6468
6469 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6470 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6471 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6472 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6473 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6474 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6475 work on.
6476
6477 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6478 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6479 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6480 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6481 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6482 tracepoint was hit.
6483
6484 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6485 conditions and actions.
6486
6487 @menu
6488 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6489 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6490 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
6491 * Tracepoint Actions::
6492 * Listing Tracepoints::
6493 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6494 @end menu
6495
6496 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6497 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6498
6499 @table @code
6500 @cindex set tracepoint
6501 @kindex trace
6502 @item trace
6503 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6504 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6505 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6506 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6507 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6508 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6509 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6510 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6511 running.
6512
6513 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6514
6515 @smallexample
6516 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6517
6518 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6519
6520 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6521
6522 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6523
6524 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6525 @end smallexample
6526
6527 @noindent
6528 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6529
6530 @vindex $tpnum
6531 @cindex last tracepoint number
6532 @cindex recent tracepoint number
6533 @cindex tracepoint number
6534 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6535 of the most recently set tracepoint.
6536
6537 @kindex delete tracepoint
6538 @cindex tracepoint deletion
6539 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6540 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6541 default is to delete all tracepoints.
6542
6543 Examples:
6544
6545 @smallexample
6546 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6547
6548 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6549 @end smallexample
6550
6551 @noindent
6552 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6553 @end table
6554
6555 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6556 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6557
6558 @table @code
6559 @kindex disable tracepoint
6560 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6561 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6562 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6563 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6564 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6565
6566 @kindex enable tracepoint
6567 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6568 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6569 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6570 run.
6571 @end table
6572
6573 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
6574 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6575
6576 @table @code
6577 @kindex passcount
6578 @cindex tracepoint pass count
6579 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6580 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6581 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6582 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6583 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6584 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6585 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6586 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6587 user.
6588
6589 Examples:
6590
6591 @smallexample
6592 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6593 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
6594
6595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6596 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
6597 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6599 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6603 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6604 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6605 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
6606 @end smallexample
6607 @end table
6608
6609 @node Tracepoint Actions
6610 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6611
6612 @table @code
6613 @kindex actions
6614 @cindex tracepoint actions
6615 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6616 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6617 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6618 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6619 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6620 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6621 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6622 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6623 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6624 @code{while-stepping}.
6625
6626 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6627 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6628 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6629
6630 @smallexample
6631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6632
6633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
6634
6635 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
6636 @end smallexample
6637
6638 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6639 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6640 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6641 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6642 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6643 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6644 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6645 @code{end} command.
6646
6647 @smallexample
6648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6650 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6651 > collect bar,baz
6652 > collect $regs
6653 > while-stepping 12
6654 > collect $fp, $sp
6655 > end
6656 end
6657 @end smallexample
6658
6659 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6660 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6661 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6662 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6663 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6664 special arguments are supported:
6665
6666 @table @code
6667 @item $regs
6668 collect all registers
6669
6670 @item $args
6671 collect all function arguments
6672
6673 @item $locals
6674 collect all local variables.
6675 @end table
6676
6677 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6678 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6679 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6680
6681 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6682 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6683
6684 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6685 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6686 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6687 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6688 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6689 its own @code{end} command):
6690
6691 @smallexample
6692 > while-stepping 12
6693 > collect $regs, myglobal
6694 > end
6695 >
6696 @end smallexample
6697
6698 @noindent
6699 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6700 @code{stepping}.
6701 @end table
6702
6703 @node Listing Tracepoints
6704 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6705
6706 @table @code
6707 @kindex info tracepoints
6708 @cindex information about tracepoints
6709 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6710 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6711 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6712 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6713 shown:
6714
6715 @itemize @bullet
6716 @item
6717 its number
6718 @item
6719 whether it is enabled or disabled
6720 @item
6721 its address
6722 @item
6723 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6724 @item
6725 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6726 @item
6727 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6728 @item
6729 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6730 @end itemize
6731
6732 @smallexample
6733 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6734 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6735 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6736 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6737 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6738 (@value{GDBP})
6739 @end smallexample
6740
6741 @noindent
6742 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6743 @end table
6744
6745 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6746 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6747
6748 @table @code
6749 @kindex tstart
6750 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6751 @cindex collected data discarded
6752 @item tstart
6753 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6754 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6755 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6756 experiment.
6757
6758 @kindex tstop
6759 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6760 @item tstop
6761 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6762 stops collecting data.
6763
6764 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6765 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6766 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6767
6768 @kindex tstatus
6769 @cindex status of trace data collection
6770 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6771 @item tstatus
6772 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6773 collection.
6774 @end table
6775
6776 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6777
6778 @smallexample
6779 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6780 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6781 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6782 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6783 > while-stepping 11
6784 > collect $regs
6785 > end
6786 > end
6787 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6788 [time passes @dots{}]
6789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6790 @end smallexample
6791
6792
6793 @node Analyze Collected Data
6794 @section Using the collected data
6795
6796 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6797 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6798 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6799 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6800 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6801 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6802 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6803 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6804 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6805 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6806 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6807 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6808 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6809 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6810 the buffer will fail.
6811
6812 @menu
6813 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6814 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6815 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6816 @end menu
6817
6818 @node tfind
6819 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6820
6821 @kindex tfind
6822 @cindex select trace snapshot
6823 @cindex find trace snapshot
6824 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6825 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6826 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6827 snapshot is selected.
6828
6829 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6830
6831 @table @code
6832 @item tfind start
6833 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6834 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6835
6836 @item tfind none
6837 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6838
6839 @item tfind end
6840 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6841
6842 @item tfind
6843 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6844
6845 @item tfind -
6846 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6847 retracing earlier steps.
6848
6849 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6850 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6851 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6852 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6853 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6854
6855 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6856 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6857 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6858 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6859 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6860
6861 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6862 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6863 addresses.
6864
6865 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6866 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6867 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6868
6869 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6870 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6871 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6872 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6873 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6874 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6875 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6876 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6877 @end table
6878
6879 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6880 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6881 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6882 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6883 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6884 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6885 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6886 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6887 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6888 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6889 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6890 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6891 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6892 tracepoint as the current one.
6893
6894 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6895 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6896 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6897 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6898 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6899
6900 @smallexample
6901 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6902 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6903 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6904 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6905 > tfind
6906 > end
6907
6908 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6909 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6910 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6911 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6912 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6913 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6914 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6915 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6916 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6917 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6918 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6919 @end smallexample
6920
6921 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6922 the buffer:
6923
6924 @smallexample
6925 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6926 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6927 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6928 > tfind line
6929 > end
6930
6931 Frame 0, X = 1
6932 Frame 7, X = 2
6933 Frame 13, X = 255
6934 @end smallexample
6935
6936 @node tdump
6937 @subsection @code{tdump}
6938 @kindex tdump
6939 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6940 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6941
6942 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6943 the current trace snapshot.
6944
6945 @smallexample
6946 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6947 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6948 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6949 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6950 > end
6951
6952 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6953
6954 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6955 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6956 at gdb_test.c:444
6957 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6958
6959 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6960 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6961 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6962 d1 0x18 24
6963 d2 0x80 128
6964 d3 0x33 51
6965 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6966 d5 0x22 34
6967 d6 0xe0 224
6968 d7 0x380035 3670069
6969 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6970 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6971 a2 0x100 256
6972 a3 0x322000 3284992
6973 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6974 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6975 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6976 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6977 ps 0x0 0
6978 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6979 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6980 fpstatus 0x0 0
6981 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6982 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6983 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6984 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6985 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6986 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6987 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6988 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6989 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6990
6991 (@value{GDBP})
6992 @end smallexample
6993
6994 @node save-tracepoints
6995 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6996 @kindex save-tracepoints
6997 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6998
6999 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7000 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7001 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7002 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7003 Files}).
7004
7005 @node Tracepoint Variables
7006 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7007 @cindex tracepoint variables
7008 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7009
7010 @table @code
7011 @vindex $trace_frame
7012 @item (int) $trace_frame
7013 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7014 snapshot is selected.
7015
7016 @vindex $tracepoint
7017 @item (int) $tracepoint
7018 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7019
7020 @vindex $trace_line
7021 @item (int) $trace_line
7022 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7023
7024 @vindex $trace_file
7025 @item (char []) $trace_file
7026 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7027
7028 @vindex $trace_func
7029 @item (char []) $trace_func
7030 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7031 @end table
7032
7033 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7034 use @code{output} instead.
7035
7036 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7037 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7038 data.
7039
7040 @smallexample
7041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7042
7043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7044 > output $trace_file
7045 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7046 > tfind
7047 > end
7048 @end smallexample
7049
7050 @node Overlays
7051 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7052 @cindex overlays
7053
7054 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7055 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7056 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7057 use overlays.
7058
7059 @menu
7060 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7061 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7062 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7063 mapped by asking the inferior.
7064 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7065 @end menu
7066
7067 @node How Overlays Work
7068 @section How Overlays Work
7069 @cindex mapped overlays
7070 @cindex unmapped overlays
7071 @cindex load address, overlay's
7072 @cindex mapped address
7073 @cindex overlay area
7074
7075 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7076 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7077 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7078 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7079 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7080
7081 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7082 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7083 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7084 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7085 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7086 largest overlay as well.
7087
7088 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7089 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7090 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7091 there.
7092
7093 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7094 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7095 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7096
7097 @smallexample
7098 @group
7099 Data Instruction Larger
7100 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7101 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7102 | | | | | |
7103 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7104 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7105 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7106 | and heap | | | | | |
7107 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7108 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7109 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7110 | | | | | |
7111 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7112 address | | | | | |
7113 | overlay | <-' | | |
7114 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7115 | | <---. | | load address
7116 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7117 | | | |
7118 +-----------+ | |
7119 +-----------+
7120 | |
7121 +-----------+
7122
7123 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7124 @end group
7125 @end smallexample
7126
7127 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7128 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7129 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7130 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7131 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7132 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7133 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7134 program and the overlay area.
7135
7136 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7137 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7138 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7139 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7140 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7141 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7142 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7143
7144 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7145 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7146 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7147
7148 @itemize @bullet
7149
7150 @item
7151 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7152 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7153 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7154 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7155
7156 @item
7157 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7158 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7159 your program's performance.
7160
7161 @item
7162 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7163 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7164 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7165 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7166 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7167 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7168 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7169
7170 @item
7171 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7172 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7173 instruction and data spaces.
7174
7175 @end itemize
7176
7177 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7178 improved in many ways:
7179
7180 @itemize @bullet
7181
7182 @item
7183 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7184 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7185 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7186 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7187 area in the usual way.
7188
7189 @item
7190 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7191 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7192
7193 @item
7194 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7195 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7196 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7197 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7198 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7199 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7200 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7201
7202 @end itemize
7203
7204
7205 @node Overlay Commands
7206 @section Overlay Commands
7207
7208 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7209 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7210 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7211 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7212 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7213 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7214
7215 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7216 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7217
7218 @table @code
7219 @item overlay off
7220 @kindex overlay off
7221 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7222 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7223 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7224 overlay support is disabled.
7225
7226 @item overlay manual
7227 @kindex overlay manual
7228 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7229 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7230 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7231 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7232 commands described below.
7233
7234 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7235 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7236 @kindex overlay map-overlay
7237 @cindex map an overlay
7238 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7239 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7240 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7241 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7242 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7243 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7244
7245 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7246 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7247 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7248 @cindex unmap an overlay
7249 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7250 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7251 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7252 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7253
7254 @item overlay auto
7255 @kindex overlay auto
7256 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7257 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7258 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7259 Overlay Debugging}.
7260
7261 @item overlay load-target
7262 @itemx overlay load
7263 @kindex overlay load-target
7264 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7265 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7266 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7267 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7268 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7269 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7270
7271 @item overlay list-overlays
7272 @itemx overlay list
7273 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7274 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7275 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7276
7277 @end table
7278
7279 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7280 of the function the address falls in:
7281
7282 @smallexample
7283 (gdb) print main
7284 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7285 @end smallexample
7286 @noindent
7287 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7288 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7289 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7290 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7291
7292 @smallexample
7293 (gdb) overlay list
7294 No sections are mapped.
7295 (gdb) print foo
7296 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7297 @end smallexample
7298 @noindent
7299 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7300 name normally:
7301
7302 @smallexample
7303 (gdb) overlay list
7304 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7305 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7306 (gdb) print foo
7307 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7308 @end smallexample
7309
7310 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7311 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7312 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7313 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7314 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7315
7316 @itemize @bullet
7317 @item
7318 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7319 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7320 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7321 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7322 @item
7323 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7324 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7325 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7326 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7327 breakpoints properly.
7328 @end itemize
7329
7330
7331 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7332 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7333 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
7334
7335 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7336 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7337 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7338 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7339 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7340 current state of the overlays.
7341
7342 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7343 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7344
7345 @table @asis
7346
7347 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
7348 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7349
7350 @smallexample
7351 struct
7352 @{
7353 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7354 unsigned long vma;
7355
7356 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7357 unsigned long size;
7358
7359 /* The overlay's load address. */
7360 unsigned long lma;
7361
7362 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7363 zero otherwise. */
7364 unsigned long mapped;
7365 @}
7366 @end smallexample
7367
7368 @item @code{_novlys}:
7369 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7370 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7371
7372 @end table
7373
7374 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7375 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7376 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7377 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7378 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7379 currently mapped.
7380
7381 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
7382 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
7383 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7384 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7385 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7386 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7387 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7388 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7389 are not being executed.
7390
7391 @node Overlay Sample Program
7392 @section Overlay Sample Program
7393 @cindex overlay example program
7394
7395 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7396 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7397 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7398 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7399 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7400 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7401 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7402
7403 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7404 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7405 suite. The program consists of the following files from
7406 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7407
7408 @table @file
7409 @item overlays.c
7410 The main program file.
7411 @item ovlymgr.c
7412 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7413 @item foo.c
7414 @itemx bar.c
7415 @itemx baz.c
7416 @itemx grbx.c
7417 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7418 @item d10v.ld
7419 @itemx m32r.ld
7420 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7421 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7422 @end table
7423
7424 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7425 cross-compiler like this:
7426
7427 @smallexample
7428 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7429 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7430 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7431 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7432 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7433 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7434 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7435 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
7436 @end smallexample
7437
7438 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7439 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7440 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7441
7442
7443 @node Languages
7444 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7445 @cindex languages
7446
7447 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7448 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7449 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7450 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
7451 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
7452 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
7453
7454 @cindex working language
7455 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7456 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7457 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7458 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7459 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7460 language}.
7461
7462 @menu
7463 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
7464 * Show:: Displaying the language
7465 * Checks:: Type and range checks
7466 * Support:: Supported languages
7467 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
7468 @end menu
7469
7470 @node Setting
7471 @section Switching between source languages
7472
7473 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7474 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7475 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7476 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7477 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7478 are printed, etc.
7479
7480 In addition to the working language, every source file that
7481 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7482 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7483 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7484 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
7485 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
7486 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
7487 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7488 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7489 Displaying the language}.
7490
7491 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
7492 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
7493 another language. In that case, make the
7494 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7495 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7496 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7497
7498 @menu
7499 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7500 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7501 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7502 @end menu
7503
7504 @node Filenames
7505 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7506
7507 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7508 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7509
7510 @table @file
7511
7512 @item .c
7513 C source file
7514
7515 @item .C
7516 @itemx .cc
7517 @itemx .cp
7518 @itemx .cpp
7519 @itemx .cxx
7520 @itemx .c++
7521 C@t{++} source file
7522
7523 @item .m
7524 Objective-C source file
7525
7526 @item .f
7527 @itemx .F
7528 Fortran source file
7529
7530 @item .mod
7531 Modula-2 source file
7532
7533 @item .s
7534 @itemx .S
7535 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7536 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7537 @end table
7538
7539 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7540 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7541
7542 @node Manually
7543 @subsection Setting the working language
7544
7545 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7546 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7547 your program.
7548
7549 @kindex set language
7550 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7551 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
7552 a language, such as
7553 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
7554 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7555
7556 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7557 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7558 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7559 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7560 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7561 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7562 command such as:
7563
7564 @smallexample
7565 print a = b + c
7566 @end smallexample
7567
7568 @noindent
7569 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7570 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7571 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7572 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
7573
7574 @node Automatically
7575 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7576
7577 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7578 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7579 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7580 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7581 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7582 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7583 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7584 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7585 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7586
7587 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7588 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7589 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7590 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7591 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7592
7593 @node Show
7594 @section Displaying the language
7595
7596 The following commands help you find out which language is the
7597 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7598
7599 @kindex show language
7600 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7601 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
7602 @table @code
7603 @item show language
7604 Display the current working language. This is the
7605 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7606 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7607
7608 @item info frame
7609 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
7610 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
7611 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
7612 information listed here.
7613
7614 @item info source
7615 Display the source language of this source file.
7616 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
7617 information listed here.
7618 @end table
7619
7620 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7621 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7622 with a language explicitly:
7623
7624 @kindex set extension-language
7625 @kindex info extensions
7626 @table @code
7627 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7628 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7629 the source language @var{language}.
7630
7631 @item info extensions
7632 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7633 @end table
7634
7635 @node Checks
7636 @section Type and range checking
7637
7638 @quotation
7639 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7640 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7641 section documents the intended facilities.
7642 @end quotation
7643 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7644
7645 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7646 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7647 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7648 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7649 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7650 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7651 errors when your program is running.
7652
7653 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7654 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7655 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7656 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7657 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7658 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7659 for the default settings of supported languages.
7660
7661 @menu
7662 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7663 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7664 @end menu
7665
7666 @cindex type checking
7667 @cindex checks, type
7668 @node Type Checking
7669 @subsection An overview of type checking
7670
7671 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7672 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7673 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7674 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7675
7676 @smallexample
7677 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7678 @exdent but
7679 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7680 @end smallexample
7681
7682 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7683 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7684
7685 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7686 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7687 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7688 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7689 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7690 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7691 also issues a warning.
7692
7693 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7694 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7695 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7696 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7697 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7698 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7699
7700 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7701 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7702 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7703 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7704 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7705 details on specific languages.
7706
7707 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7708
7709 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7710 @kindex set check type
7711 @kindex show check type
7712 @table @code
7713 @item set check type auto
7714 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7715 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7716 each language.
7717
7718 @item set check type on
7719 @itemx set check type off
7720 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7721 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7722 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7723 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7724 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7725
7726 @item set check type warn
7727 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7728 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7729 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7730 numbers and structures.
7731
7732 @item show type
7733 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7734 is setting it automatically.
7735 @end table
7736
7737 @cindex range checking
7738 @cindex checks, range
7739 @node Range Checking
7740 @subsection An overview of range checking
7741
7742 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7743 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7744 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7745 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7746 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7747
7748 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7749 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7750 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7751 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7752
7753 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7754 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7755 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7756 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7757 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7758 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7759
7760 @smallexample
7761 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7762 @end smallexample
7763
7764 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7765 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7766 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7767
7768 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7769
7770 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7771 @kindex set check range
7772 @kindex show check range
7773 @table @code
7774 @item set check range auto
7775 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7776 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7777 each language.
7778
7779 @item set check range on
7780 @itemx set check range off
7781 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7782 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7783 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7784 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7785
7786 @item set check range warn
7787 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7788 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7789 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7790 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7791 systems).
7792
7793 @item show range
7794 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7795 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7796 @end table
7797
7798 @node Support
7799 @section Supported languages
7800
7801 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
7802 @c This is false ...
7803 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7804 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7805 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7806 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7807 language.
7808
7809 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7810 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7811 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7812 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7813 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7814 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7815 language reference or tutorial.
7816
7817 @menu
7818 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7819 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
7820 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7821 @end menu
7822
7823 @node C
7824 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7825
7826 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7827 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7828
7829 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7830 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7831 together.
7832
7833 @cindex C@t{++}
7834 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7835 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7836 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7837 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7838 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7839 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7840 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7841
7842 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7843 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7844 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7845 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7846 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7847 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
7848
7849 @menu
7850 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7851 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7852 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7853 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7854 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7855 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7856 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7857 @end menu
7858
7859 @node C Operators
7860 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7861
7862 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7863
7864 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7865 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7866 often defined on groups of types.
7867
7868 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7869
7870 @itemize @bullet
7871
7872 @item
7873 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7874 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7875
7876 @item
7877 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7878 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7879
7880 @item
7881 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7882
7883 @item
7884 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7885
7886 @end itemize
7887
7888 @noindent
7889 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7890 in order of increasing precedence:
7891
7892 @table @code
7893 @item ,
7894 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7895 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7896 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7897
7898 @item =
7899 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7900 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7901
7902 @item @var{op}=
7903 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7904 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7905 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7906 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7907 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7908
7909 @item ?:
7910 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7911 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7912 integral type.
7913
7914 @item ||
7915 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7916
7917 @item &&
7918 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7919
7920 @item |
7921 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7922
7923 @item ^
7924 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7925
7926 @item &
7927 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7928
7929 @item ==@r{, }!=
7930 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7931 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7932
7933 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7934 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7935 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7936 and non-zero for true.
7937
7938 @item <<@r{, }>>
7939 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7940
7941 @item @@
7942 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7943
7944 @item +@r{, }-
7945 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7946 pointer types.
7947
7948 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7949 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7950 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7951 integral types.
7952
7953 @item ++@r{, }--
7954 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7955 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7956 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7957 operation takes place.
7958
7959 @item *
7960 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7961 @code{++}.
7962
7963 @item &
7964 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7965
7966 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7967 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
7968 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
7969 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
7970 stored.
7971
7972 @item -
7973 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7974 precedence as @code{++}.
7975
7976 @item !
7977 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7978 @code{++}.
7979
7980 @item ~
7981 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7982 @code{++}.
7983
7984
7985 @item .@r{, }->
7986 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7987 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7988 pointer based on the stored type information.
7989 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7990
7991 @item .*@r{, }->*
7992 Dereferences of pointers to members.
7993
7994 @item []
7995 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7996 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7997
7998 @item ()
7999 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8000
8001 @item ::
8002 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8003 and @code{class} types.
8004
8005 @item ::
8006 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8007 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8008 above.
8009 @end table
8010
8011 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8012 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8013 predefined meaning.
8014
8015 @menu
8016 * C Constants::
8017 @end menu
8018
8019 @node C Constants
8020 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8021
8022 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8023
8024 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8025 following ways:
8026
8027 @itemize @bullet
8028 @item
8029 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8030 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8031 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8032 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8033 @code{long} value.
8034
8035 @item
8036 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8037 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8038 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8039 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8040 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8041 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8042 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8043 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8044 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8045 constant.
8046
8047 @item
8048 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8049 integral equivalents.
8050
8051 @item
8052 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8053 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8054 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8055 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8056 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8057 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8058 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8059 @samp{\n} for newline.
8060
8061 @item
8062 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8063 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8064 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8065 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8066 characters.
8067
8068 @item
8069 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8070 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8071
8072 @item
8073 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8074 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8075 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8076 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8077 @end itemize
8078
8079 @menu
8080 * C plus plus expressions::
8081 * C Defaults::
8082 * C Checks::
8083
8084 * Debugging C::
8085 @end menu
8086
8087 @node C plus plus expressions
8088 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8089
8090 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8091 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8092
8093 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8094 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
8095 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8096 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
8097 @quotation
8098 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8099 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8100 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8101 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8102 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8103 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8104 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8105 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8106 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8107 C@t{++} code.
8108 @end quotation
8109
8110 @enumerate
8111
8112 @cindex member functions
8113 @item
8114 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8115
8116 @smallexample
8117 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8118 @end smallexample
8119
8120 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8121 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8122 @item
8123 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8124 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8125 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8126 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8127
8128 @cindex call overloaded functions
8129 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8130 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8131 @item
8132 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8133 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8134 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8135 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8136 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8137 default arguments.
8138
8139 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8140 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8141 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8142 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8143 number of function arguments.
8144
8145 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8146 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8147 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8148
8149 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8150 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8151 @smallexample
8152 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8153 @end smallexample
8154
8155 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8156 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8157
8158 @cindex reference declarations
8159 @item
8160 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8161 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8162 dereferenced.
8163
8164 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8165 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8166 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8167 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8168 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8169
8170 @item
8171 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8172 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8173 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8174 necessary, for example in an expression like
8175 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8176 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8177 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8178 @end enumerate
8179
8180 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8181 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8182 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8183 invoking user-defined operators.
8184
8185 @node C Defaults
8186 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8187
8188 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8189
8190 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8191 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8192 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8193 selects the working language.
8194
8195 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8196 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8197 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8198 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8199 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8200 for further details.
8201
8202 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8203 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8204 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8205
8206 @node C Checks
8207 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8208
8209 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8210
8211 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8212 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8213 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8214
8215 @itemize @bullet
8216 @item
8217 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8218 enumerated tag.
8219
8220 @item
8221 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8222 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8223
8224 @ignore
8225 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8226 @c FIXME--beers?
8227 @item
8228 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8229 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8230 compilers.)
8231 @end ignore
8232 @end itemize
8233
8234 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8235 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8236 that is not itself an array.
8237
8238 @node Debugging C
8239 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8240
8241 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8242 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8243 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8244 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8245
8246 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8247 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8248 ,Expressions}.
8249
8250 @menu
8251 * Debugging C plus plus::
8252 @end menu
8253
8254 @node Debugging C plus plus
8255 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8256
8257 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8258
8259 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8260 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8261
8262 @table @code
8263 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8264 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8265 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8266 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8267 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8268
8269 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8270 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8271 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8272 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8273 classes.
8274 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8275
8276 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8277 @item catch throw
8278 @itemx catch catch
8279 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8280 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8281
8282 @cindex inheritance
8283 @item ptype @var{typename}
8284 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8285 @var{typename}.
8286 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8287
8288 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8289 @item set print demangle
8290 @itemx show print demangle
8291 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8292 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8293 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8294 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8295 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8296
8297 @item set print object
8298 @itemx show print object
8299 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8300 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8301
8302 @item set print vtbl
8303 @itemx show print vtbl
8304 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8305 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8306 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8307 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8308
8309 @kindex set overload-resolution
8310 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8311 @item set overload-resolution on
8312 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8313 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8314 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8315 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8316 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8317 message.
8318
8319 @item set overload-resolution off
8320 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
8321 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8322 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8323 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8324 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8325 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8326 argument types.
8327
8328 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8329 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
8330 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
8331 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8332 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8333 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8334 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8335 @end table
8336
8337 @node Objective-C
8338 @subsection Objective-C
8339
8340 @cindex Objective-C
8341 This section provides information about some commands and command
8342 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code.
8343
8344 @menu
8345 * Method Names in Commands::
8346 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
8347 @end menu
8348
8349 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
8350 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
8351
8352 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
8353 names as line specifications:
8354
8355 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
8356 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
8357 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
8358 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
8359 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
8360 @itemize
8361 @item @code{clear}
8362 @item @code{break}
8363 @item @code{info line}
8364 @item @code{jump}
8365 @item @code{list}
8366 @end itemize
8367
8368 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
8369
8370 @smallexample
8371 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
8372 @end smallexample
8373
8374 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a plus
8375 sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The
8376 class name @var{Class} and method name @var{methoName} are enclosed in
8377 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C source
8378 code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create} instance method of
8379 class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being debugged, enter:
8380
8381 @smallexample
8382 break -[Fruit create]
8383 @end smallexample
8384
8385 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
8386 enter:
8387
8388 @smallexample
8389 list +[NSText initialize]
8390 @end smallexample
8391
8392 In the current version of GDB, the plus or minus sign is required. In
8393 future versions of GDB, the plus or minus sign will be optional, but you
8394 can use it to narrow the search. It is also possible to specify just a
8395 method name:
8396
8397 @smallexample
8398 break create
8399 @end smallexample
8400
8401 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
8402 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
8403 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
8404 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
8405 none apply.
8406
8407 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
8408 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
8409
8410 @smallexample
8411 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
8412 @end smallexample
8413
8414 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
8415 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
8416
8417 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
8418
8419 @smallexample
8420 print -[object hash]
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
8424 will tell gdb to send the -hash message to object and print the
8425 result. Also an additional command has been added, @code{print-object}
8426 or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print the description of an
8427 object. However, this command may only work with certain Objective-C
8428 libraries that have a particular hook function, called
8429 @code{_NSPrintForDebugger} defined.
8430
8431 @node Modula-2, , Objective-C, Support
8432 @subsection Modula-2
8433
8434 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
8435
8436 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8437 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8438 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8439 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8440 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8441 table.
8442
8443 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
8444 @menu
8445 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8446 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8447 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8448 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8449 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8450 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8451 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8452 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8453 @end menu
8454
8455 @node M2 Operators
8456 @subsubsection Operators
8457 @cindex Modula-2 operators
8458
8459 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8460 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8461 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8462 following definitions hold:
8463
8464 @itemize @bullet
8465
8466 @item
8467 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8468 their subranges.
8469
8470 @item
8471 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8472
8473 @item
8474 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8475
8476 @item
8477 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8478 @var{type}}.
8479
8480 @item
8481 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8482
8483 @item
8484 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8485
8486 @item
8487 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8488 @end itemize
8489
8490 @noindent
8491 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8492 increasing precedence:
8493
8494 @table @code
8495 @item ,
8496 Function argument or array index separator.
8497
8498 @item :=
8499 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8500 @var{value}.
8501
8502 @item <@r{, }>
8503 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8504 types.
8505
8506 @item <=@r{, }>=
8507 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
8508 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8509 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8510
8511 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8512 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8513 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8514 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8515 comment character.
8516
8517 @item IN
8518 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8519 Same precedence as @code{<}.
8520
8521 @item OR
8522 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8523
8524 @item AND@r{, }&
8525 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8526
8527 @item @@
8528 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8529
8530 @item +@r{, }-
8531 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8532 and difference on set types.
8533
8534 @item *
8535 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8536 on set types.
8537
8538 @item /
8539 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8540 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8541
8542 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
8543 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8544 precedence as @code{*}.
8545
8546 @item -
8547 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8548
8549 @item ^
8550 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8551
8552 @item NOT
8553 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8554 @code{^}.
8555
8556 @item .
8557 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8558 precedence as @code{^}.
8559
8560 @item []
8561 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8562
8563 @item ()
8564 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8565 as @code{^}.
8566
8567 @item ::@r{, }.
8568 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8569 @end table
8570
8571 @quotation
8572 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8573 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8574 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8575 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8576 @end quotation
8577
8578
8579 @node Built-In Func/Proc
8580 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
8581 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
8582
8583 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8584 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8585
8586 @table @var
8587
8588 @item a
8589 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8590
8591 @item c
8592 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8593
8594 @item i
8595 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8596
8597 @item m
8598 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8599 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8600 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8601
8602 @item n
8603 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8604
8605 @item r
8606 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8607
8608 @item t
8609 represents a type.
8610
8611 @item v
8612 represents a variable.
8613
8614 @item x
8615 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8616 explanation of the function for details.
8617 @end table
8618
8619 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8620
8621 @table @code
8622 @item ABS(@var{n})
8623 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8624
8625 @item CAP(@var{c})
8626 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
8627 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
8628
8629 @item CHR(@var{i})
8630 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8631
8632 @item DEC(@var{v})
8633 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8634
8635 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8636 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8637 new value.
8638
8639 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8640 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8641 set.
8642
8643 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
8644 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8645
8646 @item HIGH(@var{a})
8647 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8648
8649 @item INC(@var{v})
8650 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8651
8652 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8653 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8654 new value.
8655
8656 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8657 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8658 there. Returns the new set.
8659
8660 @item MAX(@var{t})
8661 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8662
8663 @item MIN(@var{t})
8664 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8665
8666 @item ODD(@var{i})
8667 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8668
8669 @item ORD(@var{x})
8670 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
8671 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8672 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
8673 integral, character and enumerated types.
8674
8675 @item SIZE(@var{x})
8676 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8677
8678 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
8679 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8680
8681 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8682 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8683 @end table
8684
8685 @quotation
8686 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8687 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8688 an error.
8689 @end quotation
8690
8691 @cindex Modula-2 constants
8692 @node M2 Constants
8693 @subsubsection Constants
8694
8695 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8696 ways:
8697
8698 @itemize @bullet
8699
8700 @item
8701 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8702 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8703 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8704 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8705
8706 @item
8707 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8708 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8709 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8710 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8711 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8712 digits.
8713
8714 @item
8715 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8716 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
8717 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
8718 followed by a @samp{C}.
8719
8720 @item
8721 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8722 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8723 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
8724 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
8725 sequences.
8726
8727 @item
8728 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8729
8730 @item
8731 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8732 @code{FALSE}.
8733
8734 @item
8735 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8736
8737 @item
8738 Set constants are not yet supported.
8739 @end itemize
8740
8741 @node M2 Defaults
8742 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8743 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8744
8745 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8746 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8747 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8748 selected the working language.
8749
8750 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8751 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8752 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8753 the language automatically}, for further details.
8754
8755 @node Deviations
8756 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8757 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8758
8759 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8760 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8761
8762 @itemize @bullet
8763 @item
8764 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8765 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8766 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8767 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8768 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8769 returned a pointer.)
8770
8771 @item
8772 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8773 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8774 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8775 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8776
8777 @item
8778 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8779 argument.
8780
8781 @item
8782 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8783 @end itemize
8784
8785 @node M2 Checks
8786 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8787 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8788
8789 @quotation
8790 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8791 range checking.
8792 @end quotation
8793 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8794
8795 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8796
8797 @itemize @bullet
8798 @item
8799 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8800 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8801
8802 @item
8803 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8804 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8805 @end itemize
8806
8807 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8808 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8809
8810 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8811 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8812
8813 @node M2 Scope
8814 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8815 @cindex scope
8816 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8817 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8818 @ifinfo
8819 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8820 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8821 @end ifinfo
8822 @iftex
8823 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8824 @end iftex
8825
8826 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8827 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8828 similar syntax:
8829
8830 @smallexample
8831
8832 @var{module} . @var{id}
8833 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8834 @end smallexample
8835
8836 @noindent
8837 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8838 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8839 identifier within your program, except another module.
8840
8841 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8842 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8843 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8844 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8845
8846 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8847 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8848 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8849 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8850 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8851 @var{module}.
8852
8853 @node GDB/M2
8854 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8855
8856 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8857 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8858 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8859 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8860 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8861 analogue in Modula-2.
8862
8863 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8864 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8865 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8866 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8867 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8868 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8869
8870 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8871 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8872 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8873
8874 @node Unsupported languages
8875 @section Unsupported languages
8876
8877 @cindex unsupported languages
8878 @cindex minimal language
8879 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
8880 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
8881 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
8882 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
8883 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
8884 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
8885
8886 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
8887 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
8888 language.
8889
8890 @node Symbols
8891 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8892
8893 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8894 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8895 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8896 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8897 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8898 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8899 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8900
8901 @cindex symbol names
8902 @cindex names of symbols
8903 @cindex quoting names
8904 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8905 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8906 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8907 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8908 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8909 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8910 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8911 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8912
8913 @smallexample
8914 p 'foo.c'::x
8915 @end smallexample
8916
8917 @noindent
8918 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8919
8920 @table @code
8921 @kindex info address
8922 @cindex address of a symbol
8923 @item info address @var{symbol}
8924 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8925 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8926 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8927 is always stored.
8928
8929 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8930 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8931 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8932
8933 @kindex info symbol
8934 @cindex symbol from address
8935 @item info symbol @var{addr}
8936 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8937 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8938 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8939
8940 @smallexample
8941 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8942 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8943 @end smallexample
8944
8945 @noindent
8946 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8947 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8948
8949 @kindex whatis
8950 @item whatis @var{expr}
8951 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
8952 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8953 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8954 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8955
8956 @item whatis
8957 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8958
8959 @kindex ptype
8960 @item ptype @var{typename}
8961 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
8962 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8963 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8964 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8965
8966 @item ptype @var{expr}
8967 @itemx ptype
8968 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
8969 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8970 of just the name of the type.
8971
8972 For example, for this variable declaration:
8973
8974 @smallexample
8975 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8976 @end smallexample
8977
8978 @noindent
8979 the two commands give this output:
8980
8981 @smallexample
8982 @group
8983 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8984 type = struct complex
8985 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8986 type = struct complex @{
8987 double real;
8988 double imag;
8989 @}
8990 @end group
8991 @end smallexample
8992
8993 @noindent
8994 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8995 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8996
8997 @kindex info types
8998 @item info types @var{regexp}
8999 @itemx info types
9000 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
9001 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9002 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9003 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
9004 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
9005 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9006
9007 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9008 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9009 lists all source files where a type is defined.
9010
9011 @kindex info scope
9012 @cindex local variables
9013 @item info scope @var{addr}
9014 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9015 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9016 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9017 scope defined by that location. For example:
9018
9019 @smallexample
9020 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9021 Scope for command_line_handler:
9022 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9023 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9024 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9025 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9026 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9027 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9028 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9029 @end smallexample
9030
9031 @noindent
9032 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9033 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9034 collect}.
9035
9036 @kindex info source
9037 @item info source
9038 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9039 the function containing the current point of execution:
9040 @itemize @bullet
9041 @item
9042 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9043 @item
9044 the directory it was compiled in,
9045 @item
9046 its length, in lines,
9047 @item
9048 which programming language it is written in,
9049 @item
9050 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9051 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9052 @item
9053 whether the debugging information includes information about
9054 preprocessor macros.
9055 @end itemize
9056
9057
9058 @kindex info sources
9059 @item info sources
9060 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9061 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9062 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9063
9064 @kindex info functions
9065 @item info functions
9066 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9067
9068 @item info functions @var{regexp}
9069 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9070 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9071 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9072 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
9073 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9074 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9075 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
9076
9077 @kindex info variables
9078 @item info variables
9079 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
9080 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
9081
9082 @item info variables @var{regexp}
9083 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9084 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9085 @var{regexp}.
9086
9087 @kindex info classes
9088 @item info classes
9089 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
9090 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
9091 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9092 expression.
9093
9094 @kindex info selectors
9095 @item info selectors
9096 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
9097 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
9098 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9099 expression.
9100
9101 @ignore
9102 This was never implemented.
9103 @kindex info methods
9104 @item info methods
9105 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9106 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
9107 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9108 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9109 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
9110 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9111 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9112 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9113 @end ignore
9114
9115 @cindex reloading symbols
9116 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
9117 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9118 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9119 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9120 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
9121
9122 @table @code
9123 @kindex set symbol-reloading
9124 @item set symbol-reloading on
9125 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9126 object file with a particular name is seen again.
9127
9128 @item set symbol-reloading off
9129 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9130 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9131 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9132 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9133 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9134 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9135 name.
9136
9137 @kindex show symbol-reloading
9138 @item show symbol-reloading
9139 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9140 @end table
9141
9142 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9143 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
9144 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9145 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9146 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9147 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9148 another source file. The default is on.
9149
9150 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9151 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9152
9153 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
9154 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9155 is printed as follows:
9156 @smallexample
9157 @{<no data fields>@}
9158 @end smallexample
9159
9160 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9161 @item show opaque-type-resolution
9162 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
9163
9164 @kindex maint print symbols
9165 @cindex symbol dump
9166 @kindex maint print psymbols
9167 @cindex partial symbol dump
9168 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9169 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9170 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9171 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9172 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9173 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9174 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9175 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9176 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9177 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9178 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9179 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9180 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9181 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9182 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9183 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9184 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9185
9186 @kindex maint info symtabs
9187 @kindex maint info psymtabs
9188 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
9189 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9190 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9191 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9192 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9193 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9194
9195 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
9196 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
9197 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
9198 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
9199 structure in more detail. For example:
9200
9201 @smallexample
9202 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
9203 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9204 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9205 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9206 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
9207 readin no
9208 fullname (null)
9209 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
9210 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
9211 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
9212 dependencies (none)
9213 @}
9214 @}
9215 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9216 (@value{GDBP})
9217 @end smallexample
9218 @noindent
9219 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
9220 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
9221 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
9222 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
9223 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
9224
9225 @smallexample
9226 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
9227 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
9228 line 1574.
9229 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9230 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9231 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9232 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9233 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
9234 dirname (null)
9235 fullname (null)
9236 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
9237 debugformat DWARF 2
9238 @}
9239 @}
9240 (@value{GDBP})
9241 @end smallexample
9242 @end table
9243
9244
9245 @node Altering
9246 @chapter Altering Execution
9247
9248 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9249 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9250 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9251 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9252 program.
9253
9254 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
9255 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9256 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
9257
9258 @menu
9259 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9260 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
9261 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
9262 * Returning:: Returning from a function
9263 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9264 * Patching:: Patching your program
9265 @end menu
9266
9267 @node Assignment
9268 @section Assignment to variables
9269
9270 @cindex assignment
9271 @cindex setting variables
9272 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9273 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9274
9275 @smallexample
9276 print x=4
9277 @end smallexample
9278
9279 @noindent
9280 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
9281 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
9282 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9283 information on operators in supported languages.
9284
9285 @kindex set variable
9286 @cindex variables, setting
9287 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9288 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9289 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9290 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9291 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9292
9293 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9294 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9295 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9296 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9297 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9298 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9299 command @code{set width}:
9300
9301 @smallexample
9302 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9303 type = double
9304 (@value{GDBP}) p width
9305 $4 = 13
9306 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9307 Invalid syntax in expression.
9308 @end smallexample
9309
9310 @noindent
9311 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9312 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9313
9314 @smallexample
9315 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
9316 @end smallexample
9317
9318 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9319 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9320 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9321 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9322 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9323 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9324
9325 @smallexample
9326 @group
9327 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9328 type = double
9329 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9330 $1 = 1
9331 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
9332 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9333 $2 = 1
9334 (@value{GDBP}) r
9335 The program being debugged has been started already.
9336 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9337 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
9338 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9339 Invalid bfd target.
9340 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9341 The current BFD target is "=4".
9342 @end group
9343 @end smallexample
9344
9345 @noindent
9346 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9347 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9348 @code{g}, use
9349
9350 @smallexample
9351 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9352 @end smallexample
9353
9354 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9355 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9356 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9357 same length or shorter.
9358 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9359 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9360
9361 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9362 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9363 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9364 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9365 and representation in memory), and
9366
9367 @smallexample
9368 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9369 @end smallexample
9370
9371 @noindent
9372 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9373
9374 @node Jumping
9375 @section Continuing at a different address
9376
9377 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9378 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9379 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9380
9381 @table @code
9382 @kindex jump
9383 @item jump @var{linespec}
9384 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9385 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9386 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9387 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9388 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9389 breakpoints}.
9390
9391 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9392 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9393 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9394 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9395 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9396 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9397 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9398 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9399 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9400
9401 @item jump *@var{address}
9402 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9403 @end table
9404
9405 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9406 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9407 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9408 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9409 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9410 example,
9411
9412 @smallexample
9413 set $pc = 0x485
9414 @end smallexample
9415
9416 @noindent
9417 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9418 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9419 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9420
9421 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9422 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9423 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9424 detail.
9425
9426 @c @group
9427 @node Signaling
9428 @section Giving your program a signal
9429
9430 @table @code
9431 @kindex signal
9432 @item signal @var{signal}
9433 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9434 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9435 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9436 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9437
9438 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9439 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9440 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9441 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9442 signal.
9443
9444 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9445 after executing the command.
9446 @end table
9447 @c @end group
9448
9449 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9450 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9451 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9452 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9453 passes the signal directly to your program.
9454
9455
9456 @node Returning
9457 @section Returning from a function
9458
9459 @table @code
9460 @cindex returning from a function
9461 @kindex return
9462 @item return
9463 @itemx return @var{expression}
9464 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9465 command. If you give an
9466 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9467 value.
9468 @end table
9469
9470 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9471 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9472 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9473 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9474
9475 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9476 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9477 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9478 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9479 of functions.
9480
9481 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9482 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9483 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9484 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9485 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9486
9487 @node Calling
9488 @section Calling program functions
9489
9490 @cindex calling functions
9491 @kindex call
9492 @table @code
9493 @item call @var{expr}
9494 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9495 returned values.
9496 @end table
9497
9498 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9499 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9500 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9501 is printed and saved in the value history.
9502
9503 @node Patching
9504 @section Patching programs
9505
9506 @cindex patching binaries
9507 @cindex writing into executables
9508 @cindex writing into corefiles
9509
9510 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9511 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9512 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9513 patching your program's binary.
9514
9515 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9516 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9517 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9518 repairs.
9519
9520 @table @code
9521 @kindex set write
9522 @item set write on
9523 @itemx set write off
9524 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9525 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9526 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9527
9528 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9529 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9530 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9531
9532 @item show write
9533 @kindex show write
9534 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9535 as well as reading.
9536 @end table
9537
9538 @node GDB Files
9539 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9540
9541 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9542 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9543 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9544 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9545
9546 @menu
9547 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9548 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
9549 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9550 @end menu
9551
9552 @node Files
9553 @section Commands to specify files
9554
9555 @cindex symbol table
9556 @cindex core dump file
9557
9558 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9559 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9560 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9561 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9562
9563 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9564 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9565 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9566 to specify new files are useful.
9567
9568 @table @code
9569 @cindex executable file
9570 @kindex file
9571 @item file @var{filename}
9572 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9573 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9574 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9575 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9576 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9577 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9578 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9579 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9580
9581 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9582 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9583 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9584 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9585 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9586 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9587 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9588 for more information.
9589
9590 @item file
9591 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9592 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9593
9594 @kindex exec-file
9595 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9596 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9597 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9598 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9599 discard information on the executable file.
9600
9601 @kindex symbol-file
9602 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9603 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9604 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9605 table and program to run from the same file.
9606
9607 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9608 program's symbol table.
9609
9610 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9611 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9612 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9613 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9614 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9615
9616 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9617 executing it once.
9618
9619 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9620 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9621 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9622 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9623 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9624 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9625 optimized code.
9626
9627 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9628 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9629 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9630 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9631 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9632
9633 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9634 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9635 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9636 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9637 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9638 warnings and messages}.)
9639
9640 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9641 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9642 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9643 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9644 in stabs format.
9645
9646 @kindex readnow
9647 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9648 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9649 @kindex mapped
9650 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9651 @cindex saving symbol table
9652 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9653 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9654 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9655 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9656 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9657 entire symbol table available.
9658
9659 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9660 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9661 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9662 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9663 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9664 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9665 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9666 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9667
9668 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9669 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9670
9671 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9672 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9673 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9674 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9675 needed.
9676
9677 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9678 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9679 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9680
9681 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9682 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9683 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9684 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9685 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9686 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9687 @c files.
9688
9689 @kindex core
9690 @kindex core-file
9691 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9692 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9693 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9694 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9695 executable file itself for other parts.
9696
9697 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9698 to be used.
9699
9700 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9701 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9702 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9703 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9704 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9705
9706 @kindex add-symbol-file
9707 @cindex dynamic linking
9708 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9709 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9710 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9711 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9712 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9713 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9714 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9715 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9716 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9717 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9718 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9719 @var{address} as an expression.
9720
9721 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9722 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9723 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9724 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9725 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9726
9727 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9728 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9729 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9730 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9731 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9732 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9733 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9734 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9735 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9736
9737 @itemize @bullet
9738 @item
9739 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9740 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9741 @item
9742 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9743 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9744 @item
9745 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9746 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9747 @end itemize
9748
9749 @noindent
9750 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9751 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9752 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9753 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9754 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9755 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9756 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9757 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9758 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9759 way.
9760
9761 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9762
9763 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9764 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9765 table information for @var{filename}.
9766
9767 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9768 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9769 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9770 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9771 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9772 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9773
9774 @kindex section
9775 @item section
9776 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9777 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9778 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9779 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9780 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9781 the sections and their addresses.
9782
9783 @kindex info files
9784 @kindex info target
9785 @item info files
9786 @itemx info target
9787 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9788 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9789 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9790 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9791 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9792 current ones.
9793
9794 @kindex maint info sections
9795 @item maint info sections
9796 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9797 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9798 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9799 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9800 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9801 may be arbitrarily combined):
9802
9803 @table @code
9804 @item ALLOBJ
9805 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9806 @item @var{sections}
9807 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9808 @item @var{section-flags}
9809 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9810 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9811 @table @code
9812 @item ALLOC
9813 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9814 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9815 @item LOAD
9816 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9817 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9818 @item RELOC
9819 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9820 @item READONLY
9821 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9822 @item CODE
9823 Section contains executable code only.
9824 @item DATA
9825 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9826 @item ROM
9827 Section will reside in ROM.
9828 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9829 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9830 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9831 Section is not empty.
9832 @item NEVER_LOAD
9833 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9834 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9835 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9836 COFF shared library information.
9837 @item IS_COMMON
9838 Section contains common symbols.
9839 @end table
9840 @end table
9841 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9842 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9843 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9844 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9845 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9846 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9847 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9848 enhancement to debugging performance.
9849
9850 The default is off.
9851
9852 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9853 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9854 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9855 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9856 @end table
9857
9858 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9859 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9860 name and remembers it that way.
9861
9862 @cindex shared libraries
9863 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9864 libraries.
9865
9866 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9867 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9868 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9869 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9870 debugging a core file).
9871
9872 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9873 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9874
9875 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9876 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9877 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9878
9879 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9880 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9881 particularly large or there are many of them.
9882
9883 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9884 commands:
9885
9886 @table @code
9887 @kindex set auto-solib-add
9888 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9889 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9890 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9891 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9892 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9893 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9894 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9895
9896 @kindex show auto-solib-add
9897 @item show auto-solib-add
9898 Display the current autoloading mode.
9899 @end table
9900
9901 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9902 command:
9903
9904 @table @code
9905 @kindex info sharedlibrary
9906 @kindex info share
9907 @item info share
9908 @itemx info sharedlibrary
9909 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9910
9911 @kindex sharedlibrary
9912 @kindex share
9913 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9914 @itemx share @var{regex}
9915 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9916 Unix regular expression.
9917 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9918 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9919 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9920 loaded.
9921 @end table
9922
9923 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9924 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9925 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9926 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9927 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9928 wish.
9929
9930 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
9931 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9932 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
9933 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9934
9935 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9936
9937 @table @code
9938 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
9939 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9940 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9941 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9942 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9943 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
9944 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9945 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
9946 Mb).
9947
9948 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
9949 @item show auto-solib-limit
9950 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9951 @end table
9952
9953 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9954 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9955 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9956 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9957 not.
9958
9959 You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9960 load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9961 @value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9962 libraries.
9963
9964 @table @code
9965 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9966 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9967 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9968 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9969 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9970 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9971 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9972 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9973
9974 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9975 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9976
9977 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9978 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
9979 Display the current shared library prefix.
9980
9981 @kindex set solib-search-path
9982 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9983 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9984 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9985 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9986 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9987 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9988 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9989 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9990
9991 @kindex show solib-search-path
9992 @item show solib-search-path
9993 Display the current shared library search path.
9994 @end table
9995
9996
9997 @node Separate Debug Files
9998 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
9999 @cindex separate debugging information files
10000 @cindex debugging information in separate files
10001 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
10002 @cindex debugging information directory, global
10003 @cindex global debugging information directory
10004
10005 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
10006 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
10007 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
10008 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
10009 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
10010 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
10011 install only when they need to debug a problem.
10012
10013 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
10014 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
10015 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
10016 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
10017 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
10018 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
10019 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
10020 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
10021 places:
10022
10023 @itemize @bullet
10024 @item
10025 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
10026 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
10027 @item
10028 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
10029 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
10030 @item
10031 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
10032 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
10033 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
10034 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
10035 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
10036 @end itemize
10037 @noindent
10038 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
10039 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
10040 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
10041
10042 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
10043 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
10044 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
10045 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
10046 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
10047 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
10048
10049 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
10050 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
10051
10052 @table @code
10053
10054 @kindex set debug-file-directory
10055 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
10056 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10057 information files to @var{directory}.
10058
10059 @kindex show debug-file-directory
10060 @item show debug-file-directory
10061 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10062 information files.
10063
10064 @end table
10065
10066 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
10067 @cindex debug links
10068 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
10069 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
10070
10071 @itemize
10072 @item
10073 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
10074 a zero byte,
10075 @item
10076 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
10077 boundary within the section, and
10078 @item
10079 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
10080 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
10081 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
10082 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
10083 @end itemize
10084
10085 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
10086 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
10087 described above.
10088
10089 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
10090 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
10091 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
10092 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
10093 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
10094 in an ordinary executable.
10095
10096 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
10097 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
10098 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
10099 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
10100 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
10101 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
10102 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
10103
10104 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
10105 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
10106 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
10107 complete code for a function that computes it:
10108
10109 @kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
10110 @smallexample
10111 unsigned long
10112 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
10113 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
10114 @{
10115 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
10116 @{
10117 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
10118 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
10119 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
10120 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
10121 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
10122 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
10123 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
10124 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
10125 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
10126 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
10127 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
10128 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
10129 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
10130 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
10131 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
10132 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
10133 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
10134 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
10135 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
10136 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
10137 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
10138 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
10139 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
10140 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
10141 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
10142 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
10143 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
10144 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
10145 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
10146 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
10147 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
10148 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
10149 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
10150 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
10151 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
10152 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
10153 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
10154 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
10155 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
10156 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
10157 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
10158 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
10159 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
10160 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
10161 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
10162 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
10163 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
10164 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
10165 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
10166 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
10167 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
10168 0x2d02ef8d
10169 @};
10170 unsigned char *end;
10171
10172 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10173 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
10174 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
10175 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10176 @}
10177 @end smallexample
10178
10179
10180 @node Symbol Errors
10181 @section Errors reading symbol files
10182
10183 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10184 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10185 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10186 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10187 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10188 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10189 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10190 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10191 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10192 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10193 messages}).
10194
10195 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10196
10197 @table @code
10198 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10199
10200 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10201 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10202 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10203 in its outer scope blocks.
10204
10205 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10206 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10207 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10208 function.
10209
10210 @item block at @var{address} out of order
10211
10212 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10213 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10214 do so.
10215
10216 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10217 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10218 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10219 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10220 messages}.)
10221
10222 @item bad block start address patched
10223
10224 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10225 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10226 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10227
10228 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10229 starting on the previous source line.
10230
10231 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10232
10233 @cindex foo
10234 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10235 larger than the size of the string table.
10236
10237 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10238 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10239 with this name.
10240
10241 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10242
10243 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10244 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
10245 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
10246
10247 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10248 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
10249 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
10250 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10251 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10252 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
10253
10254 @item stub type has NULL name
10255
10256 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
10257
10258 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
10259 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
10260 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10261 it.
10262
10263 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10264
10265 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
10266
10267 @end table
10268
10269 @node Targets
10270 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
10271
10272 @cindex debugging target
10273 @kindex target
10274
10275 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
10276
10277 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10278 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10279 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
10280 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10281 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
10282 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10283 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10284 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10285
10286 @menu
10287 * Active Targets:: Active targets
10288 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
10289 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10290 * Remote:: Remote debugging
10291 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
10292
10293 @end menu
10294
10295 @node Active Targets
10296 @section Active targets
10297
10298 @cindex stacking targets
10299 @cindex active targets
10300 @cindex multiple targets
10301
10302 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
10303 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10304 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10305 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10306 a core file.
10307
10308 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10309 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10310 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10311 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10312 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10313 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10314 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10315 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10316 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
10317
10318 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
10319 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10320 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10321 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10322 process target is active.
10323
10324 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10325 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
10326 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
10327 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10328 process}).
10329
10330 @node Target Commands
10331 @section Commands for managing targets
10332
10333 @table @code
10334 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
10335 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10336 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10337 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10338 protocol of the target machine.
10339
10340 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10341 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10342 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
10343
10344 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10345 after executing the command.
10346
10347 @kindex help target
10348 @item help target
10349 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10350 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10351 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10352
10353 @item help target @var{name}
10354 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10355 select it.
10356
10357 @kindex set gnutarget
10358 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
10359 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
10360 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
10361 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10362 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
10363 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10364
10365 @quotation
10366 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10367 you must know the actual BFD name.
10368 @end quotation
10369
10370 @noindent
10371 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
10372
10373 @kindex show gnutarget
10374 @item show gnutarget
10375 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10376 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10377 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10378 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10379 @end table
10380
10381 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10382 configuration):
10383
10384 @table @code
10385 @kindex target exec
10386 @item target exec @var{program}
10387 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10388 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10389
10390 @kindex target core
10391 @item target core @var{filename}
10392 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10393 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
10394
10395 @kindex target remote
10396 @item target remote @var{dev}
10397 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10398 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10399 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
10400 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
10401 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10402 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10403
10404 @kindex target sim
10405 @item target sim
10406 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
10407 In general,
10408 @smallexample
10409 target sim
10410 load
10411 run
10412 @end smallexample
10413 @noindent
10414 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
10415 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
10416 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10417 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10418 Processors}.
10419
10420 @end table
10421
10422 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
10423
10424 @table @code
10425
10426 @kindex target nrom
10427 @item target nrom @var{dev}
10428 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10429
10430 @end table
10431
10432 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
10433 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
10434
10435 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10436 once you've successfully established a connection.
10437
10438 @table @code
10439
10440 @kindex load @var{filename}
10441 @item load @var{filename}
10442 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10443 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10444 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10445 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10446 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10447 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10448
10449 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10450 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10451 target is @dots{}}''
10452
10453 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10454 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10455 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10456 specifies a fixed address.
10457 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10458
10459 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10460 @end table
10461
10462 @node Byte Order
10463 @section Choosing target byte order
10464
10465 @cindex choosing target byte order
10466 @cindex target byte order
10467
10468 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10469 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10470 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10471 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10472 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
10473 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
10474
10475 @table @code
10476 @kindex set endian big
10477 @item set endian big
10478 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10479
10480 @kindex set endian little
10481 @item set endian little
10482 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10483
10484 @kindex set endian auto
10485 @item set endian auto
10486 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10487 executable.
10488
10489 @item show endian
10490 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10491
10492 @end table
10493
10494 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10495 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10496 target system.
10497
10498 @node Remote
10499 @section Remote debugging
10500 @cindex remote debugging
10501
10502 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
10503 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10504 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
10505 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10506 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10507
10508 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10509 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
10510 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
10511 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10512 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10513 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10514
10515 Other remote targets may be available in your
10516 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
10517
10518 @node KOD
10519 @section Kernel Object Display
10520
10521 @cindex kernel object display
10522 @cindex kernel object
10523 @cindex KOD
10524
10525 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10526 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10527 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10528 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10529 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10530
10531 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10532 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10533
10534 @smallexample
10535 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10536 @end smallexample
10537
10538 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10539 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10540 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10541 after the operating system:
10542
10543 @smallexample
10544 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10545 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10546 Object Description
10547 any Any and all objects
10548 @end smallexample
10549
10550 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10551 by the kernel.
10552
10553 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10554 is supported other than to try it.
10555
10556
10557 @node Remote Debugging
10558 @chapter Debugging remote programs
10559
10560 @menu
10561 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
10562 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10563 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10564 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
10565 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10566 @end menu
10567
10568 @node Connecting
10569 @section Connecting to a remote target
10570
10571 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
10572 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
10573 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
10574 program as the first argument.
10575
10576 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10577 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
10578 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
10579 before the @code{target} command.
10580
10581 After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
10582 the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
10583 via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
10584 (possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
10585 target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
10586 named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10587
10588 @smallexample
10589 target remote /dev/ttyb
10590 @end smallexample
10591
10592 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10593 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10594 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10595 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10596 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10597
10598 @smallexample
10599 target remote manyfarms:2828
10600 @end smallexample
10601
10602 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10603 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10604 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10605 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10606
10607 @smallexample
10608 target remote :1234
10609 @end smallexample
10610 @noindent
10611
10612 Note that the colon is still required here.
10613
10614 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10615 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10616 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10617 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10618
10619 @smallexample
10620 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10621 @end smallexample
10622
10623 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10624 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10625 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10626 session.
10627
10628 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10629 step and continue the remote program.
10630
10631 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10632 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10633 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10634 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10635 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10636 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10637 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10638
10639 @smallexample
10640 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10641 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10642 @end smallexample
10643
10644 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10645 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10646 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10647 goes back to waiting.
10648
10649 @table @code
10650 @kindex detach (remote)
10651 @item detach
10652 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
10653 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
10654 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
10655 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
10656 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
10657
10658 @kindex disconnect
10659 @item disconnect
10660 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
10661 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
10662 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
10663 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
10664 another target.
10665 @end table
10666
10667 @node Server
10668 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10669
10670 @kindex gdbserver
10671 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10672 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10673 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10674 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10675
10676 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10677 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10678 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10679 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10680 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10681 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10682 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10683 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10684 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10685 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10686 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10687 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10688 choice for debugging.
10689
10690 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10691 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10692 protocol.
10693
10694 @table @emph
10695 @item On the target machine,
10696 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10697 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10698 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10699 system does all the symbol handling.
10700
10701 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10702 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10703 syntax is:
10704
10705 @smallexample
10706 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10707 @end smallexample
10708
10709 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10710 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10711 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10712 @file{/dev/com1}:
10713
10714 @smallexample
10715 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10716 @end smallexample
10717
10718 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10719 with it.
10720
10721 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10722
10723 @smallexample
10724 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10725 @end smallexample
10726
10727 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10728 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10729 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10730 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10731 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10732 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10733 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10734 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10735 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10736 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10737 @code{target remote} command.
10738
10739 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10740 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10741
10742 @smallexample
10743 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10744 @end smallexample
10745
10746 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10747 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10748
10749 @item On the host machine,
10750 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
10751 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10752 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10753 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10754 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
10755 command in @value{GDBN} when using gdbserver, since the program is
10756 already on the target.
10757
10758 @end table
10759
10760 @node NetWare
10761 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10762
10763 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10764 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10765 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10766 @code{target remote}.
10767
10768 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10769 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10770
10771 @table @emph
10772 @item On the target machine,
10773 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10774 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10775 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10776 host system does all the symbol handling.
10777
10778 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10779 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10780 program. The syntax is:
10781
10782 @smallexample
10783 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10784 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10785 @end smallexample
10786
10787 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10788 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10789 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10790
10791 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10792 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10793 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10794
10795 @smallexample
10796 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10797 @end smallexample
10798
10799 @item
10800 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
10801 Connecting to a remote target}).
10802
10803 @end table
10804
10805 @node Remote configuration
10806 @section Remote configuration
10807
10808 The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
10809 programs:
10810
10811 @table @code
10812 @kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
10813 @kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
10814 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
10815 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
10816 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
10817 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
10818 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
10819 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
10820 @end table
10821
10822 @node remote stub
10823 @section Implementing a remote stub
10824
10825 @cindex debugging stub, example
10826 @cindex remote stub, example
10827 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10828 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10829 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10830 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10831 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10832 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10833 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10834 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10835
10836 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10837 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10838 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10839 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10840 program, you need:
10841
10842 @enumerate
10843 @item
10844 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10845 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10846 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10847
10848 @item
10849 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10850 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10851
10852 @item
10853 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10854 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10855 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10856 documentation.
10857 @end enumerate
10858
10859 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10860 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10861 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10862
10863 @table @emph
10864 @item On the host,
10865 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10866 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10867 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10868
10869 @item On the target,
10870 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10871 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10872 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10873
10874 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10875 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10876 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10877 @end table
10878
10879 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10880 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10881 @sc{sparc} boards.
10882
10883 @cindex remote serial stub list
10884 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10885
10886 @table @code
10887
10888 @item i386-stub.c
10889 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10890 @cindex Intel
10891 @cindex i386
10892 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10893
10894 @item m68k-stub.c
10895 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10896 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10897 @cindex m680x0
10898 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10899
10900 @item sh-stub.c
10901 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10902 @cindex Hitachi
10903 @cindex SH
10904 For Hitachi SH architectures.
10905
10906 @item sparc-stub.c
10907 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10908 @cindex Sparc
10909 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10910
10911 @item sparcl-stub.c
10912 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10913 @cindex Fujitsu
10914 @cindex SparcLite
10915 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10916
10917 @end table
10918
10919 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10920 recently added stubs.
10921
10922 @menu
10923 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10924 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10925 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10926 @end menu
10927
10928 @node Stub Contents
10929 @subsection What the stub can do for you
10930
10931 @cindex remote serial stub
10932 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10933 subroutines:
10934
10935 @table @code
10936 @item set_debug_traps
10937 @kindex set_debug_traps
10938 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10939 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10940 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10941 beginning of your program.
10942
10943 @item handle_exception
10944 @kindex handle_exception
10945 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10946 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10947 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10948 run when a trap is triggered.
10949
10950 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10951 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10952 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10953 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
10954 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
10955 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10956 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10957 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10958 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
10959 machine.
10960
10961 @item breakpoint
10962 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10963 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10964 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10965 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10966 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10967 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10968 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10969 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10970 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10971 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
10972 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
10973
10974 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10975 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10976 start of your debugging session.
10977 @end table
10978
10979 @node Bootstrapping
10980 @subsection What you must do for the stub
10981
10982 @cindex remote stub, support routines
10983 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10984 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10985 debugging target machine.
10986
10987 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10988 serial port.
10989
10990 @table @code
10991 @item int getDebugChar()
10992 @kindex getDebugChar
10993 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10994 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10995 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10996
10997 @item void putDebugChar(int)
10998 @kindex putDebugChar
10999 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
11000 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
11001 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11002 @end table
11003
11004 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
11005 @cindex interrupting remote targets
11006 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
11007 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
11008 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
11009 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
11010 remote system to stop.
11011
11012 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
11013 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
11014 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
11015 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
11016
11017 Other routines you need to supply are:
11018
11019 @table @code
11020 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
11021 @kindex exceptionHandler
11022 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
11023 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
11024 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
11025 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
11026 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
11027 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
11028 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
11029 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
11030 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
11031 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
11032 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
11033 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
11034 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
11035
11036 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
11037 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
11038 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
11039 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
11040 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
11041
11042 @item void flush_i_cache()
11043 @kindex flush_i_cache
11044 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
11045 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
11046 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
11047
11048 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
11049 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
11050 @end table
11051
11052 @noindent
11053 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
11054
11055 @table @code
11056 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
11057 @kindex memset
11058 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
11059 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
11060 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
11061 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
11062 @end table
11063
11064 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
11065 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
11066 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
11067 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
11068
11069
11070 @node Debug Session
11071 @subsection Putting it all together
11072
11073 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
11074 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
11075 steps.
11076
11077 @enumerate
11078 @item
11079 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
11080 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
11081 @display
11082 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
11083 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
11084 @end display
11085
11086 @item
11087 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
11088
11089 @smallexample
11090 set_debug_traps();
11091 breakpoint();
11092 @end smallexample
11093
11094 @item
11095 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
11096 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
11097
11098 @smallexample
11099 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
11100 @end smallexample
11101
11102 @noindent
11103 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
11104 function in your program, that function is called when
11105 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
11106 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
11107 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
11108
11109 @item
11110 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
11111 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
11112
11113 @item
11114 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
11115 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
11116
11117 @item
11118 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
11119 @c document that. FIXME.
11120 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
11121 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
11122
11123 @item
11124 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
11125 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
11126
11127 @end enumerate
11128
11129 @node Configurations
11130 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
11131
11132 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11133 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11134 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
11135
11136 There are three major categories of configurations: native
11137 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11138 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11139 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11140 are quite different from each other.
11141
11142 @menu
11143 * Native::
11144 * Embedded OS::
11145 * Embedded Processors::
11146 * Architectures::
11147 @end menu
11148
11149 @node Native
11150 @section Native
11151
11152 This section describes details specific to particular native
11153 configurations.
11154
11155 @menu
11156 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
11157 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11158 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
11159 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
11160 @end menu
11161
11162 @node HP-UX
11163 @subsection HP-UX
11164
11165 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11166 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11167 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
11168
11169 @node SVR4 Process Information
11170 @subsection SVR4 process information
11171
11172 @kindex /proc
11173 @cindex process image
11174
11175 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11176 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11177 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11178 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11179 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11180 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11181 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
11182 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
11183
11184 @table @code
11185 @kindex info proc
11186 @item info proc
11187 Summarize available information about the process.
11188
11189 @kindex info proc mappings
11190 @item info proc mappings
11191 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11192 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11193 @ignore
11194 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11195 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11196 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11197 @kindex info proc times
11198 @item info proc times
11199 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11200 its children.
11201
11202 @kindex info proc id
11203 @item info proc id
11204 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11205 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
11206
11207 @kindex info proc status
11208 @item info proc status
11209 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11210 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11211 received.
11212
11213 @item info proc all
11214 Show all the above information about the process.
11215 @end ignore
11216 @end table
11217
11218 @node DJGPP Native
11219 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11220 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11221 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11222 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
11223
11224 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11225 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11226 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11227 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
11228
11229 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11230 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11231 subsection describes those commands.
11232
11233 @table @code
11234 @kindex info dos
11235 @item info dos
11236 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11237 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11238
11239 @kindex sysinfo
11240 @cindex MS-DOS system info
11241 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11242 @item info dos sysinfo
11243 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11244 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11245 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
11246
11247 @cindex GDT
11248 @cindex LDT
11249 @cindex IDT
11250 @cindex segment descriptor tables
11251 @cindex descriptor tables display
11252 @item info dos gdt
11253 @itemx info dos ldt
11254 @itemx info dos idt
11255 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11256 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11257 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11258 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11259 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11260 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11261 rights.
11262
11263 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11264 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11265 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11266 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11267 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
11268
11269 @cindex garbled pointers
11270 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11271 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11272 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11273 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11274 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11275 debugged program's data segment:
11276
11277 @smallexample
11278 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11279 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11280 @end smallexample
11281
11282 @noindent
11283 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11284 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
11285
11286 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11287 @item info dos pde
11288 @itemx info dos pte
11289 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11290 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11291 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11292 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11293 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11294 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11295 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11296 that is currently in use.
11297
11298 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11299 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11300 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11301 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11302 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11303 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11304 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
11305
11306 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11307 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11308 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11309 controller.
11310
11311 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
11312
11313 @cindex physical address from linear address
11314 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11315 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11316 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11317 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11318 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11319 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11320 the variable @code{i} is stored:
11321
11322 @smallexample
11323 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11324 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11325 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11326 @end smallexample
11327
11328 @noindent
11329 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11330 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11331 attributes of that page.
11332
11333 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11334 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11335 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11336 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11337 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11338 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11339
11340 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11341 transfer buffer:
11342
11343 @smallexample
11344 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11345 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11346 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11347 @end smallexample
11348
11349 @noindent
11350 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
11351 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11352 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11353 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11354
11355 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11356 @end table
11357
11358 @node Cygwin Native
11359 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11360 @cindex MS Windows debugging
11361 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
11362 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11363
11364 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11365 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11366 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11367 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11368 that have no debugging symbols.
11369
11370
11371 @table @code
11372 @kindex info w32
11373 @item info w32
11374 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11375 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11376
11377 @item info w32 selector
11378 This command displays information returned by
11379 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11380 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11381 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11382 Without argument, this command displays information
11383 about the the six segment registers.
11384
11385 @kindex info dll
11386 @item info dll
11387 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11388
11389 @kindex dll-symbols
11390 @item dll-symbols
11391 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11392 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11393
11394 @kindex set new-console
11395 @item set new-console @var{mode}
11396 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11397 be started in a new console on next start.
11398 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11399 be started in the same console as the debugger.
11400
11401 @kindex show new-console
11402 @item show new-console
11403 Displays whether a new console is used
11404 when the debuggee is started.
11405
11406 @kindex set new-group
11407 @item set new-group @var{mode}
11408 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11409 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11410 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11411 Ctrl-C.
11412
11413 @kindex show new-group
11414 @item show new-group
11415 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11416
11417 @kindex set debugevents
11418 @item set debugevents
11419 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11420
11421 @kindex set debugexec
11422 @item set debugexec
11423 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11424 seen by the debugger.
11425
11426 @kindex set debugexceptions
11427 @item set debugexceptions
11428 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11429 seen by the debugger.
11430
11431 @kindex set debugmemory
11432 @item set debugmemory
11433 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11434 seen by the debugger.
11435
11436 @kindex set shell
11437 @item set shell
11438 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11439 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11440
11441 @kindex show shell
11442 @item show shell
11443 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11444
11445 @end table
11446
11447 @menu
11448 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11449 @end menu
11450
11451 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
11452 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11453 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11454 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11455
11456 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11457 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11458 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11459 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11460 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11461 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11462 ``minimal symbols''.
11463
11464 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11465 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11466 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11467 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11468 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11469 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11470 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11471 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11472 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11473 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11474
11475 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11476
11477 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11478 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11479 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11480 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11481 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11482 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11483 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11484 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11485 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11486
11487 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11488 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11489 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11490 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11491 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11492 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11493
11494 @smallexample
11495 (gdb) info function CreateFileA
11496 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11497
11498 Non-debugging symbols:
11499 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
11500 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11501 @end smallexample
11502
11503 @smallexample
11504 (gdb) info function !
11505 All functions matching regular expression "!":
11506
11507 Non-debugging symbols:
11508 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
11509 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
11510 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11511 [etc...]
11512 @end smallexample
11513
11514 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11515
11516 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11517 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11518 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11519 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11520 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11521 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11522 a function within a DLL without a running program.
11523
11524 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11525 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11526 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11527 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11528 problem:
11529
11530 @smallexample
11531 (gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11532 $1 = 268572168
11533 @end smallexample
11534
11535 @smallexample
11536 (gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
11537 0x10021610: "\230y\""
11538 @end smallexample
11539
11540 And two possible solutions:
11541
11542 @smallexample
11543 (gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11544 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11545 @end smallexample
11546
11547 @smallexample
11548 (gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
11549 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11550 (gdb) x/x 0x10021608
11551 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11552 (gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
11553 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11554 @end smallexample
11555
11556 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11557 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11558 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11559 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11560 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11561
11562 @smallexample
11563 (gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11564 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11565 @end smallexample
11566
11567 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11568 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11569 safe.
11570
11571 @node Embedded OS
11572 @section Embedded Operating Systems
11573
11574 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11575 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11576 architectures.
11577
11578 @menu
11579 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11580 @end menu
11581
11582 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11583 various real-time operating systems.
11584
11585 @node VxWorks
11586 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11587
11588 @cindex VxWorks
11589
11590 @table @code
11591
11592 @kindex target vxworks
11593 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11594 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11595 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11596
11597 @end table
11598
11599 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11600 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11601
11602 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11603 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11604 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11605 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11606 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11607 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11608 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
11609
11610 @table @code
11611 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11612 @kindex vxworks-timeout
11613 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11614 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11615 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11616 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11617 of a thin network line.
11618 @end table
11619
11620 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11621 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11622 procedures.
11623
11624 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11625 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11626 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11627 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11628 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11629 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11630 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11631 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11632 manual.
11633 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11634
11635 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11636 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11637 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11638 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
11639
11640 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11641
11642 @smallexample
11643 (vxgdb)
11644 @end smallexample
11645
11646 @menu
11647 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11648 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11649 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11650 @end menu
11651
11652 @node VxWorks Connection
11653 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11654
11655 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11656 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11657
11658 @smallexample
11659 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11660 @end smallexample
11661
11662 @need 750
11663 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11664
11665 @smallexample
11666 Attaching remote machine across net...
11667 Connected to tt.
11668 @end smallexample
11669
11670 @need 1000
11671 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11672 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11673 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11674 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11675 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11676
11677 @smallexample
11678 prog.o: No such file or directory.
11679 @end smallexample
11680
11681 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11682 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11683 command again.
11684
11685 @node VxWorks Download
11686 @subsubsection VxWorks download
11687
11688 @cindex download to VxWorks
11689 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11690 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11691 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11692 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11693 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11694 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11695 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11696 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11697 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11698 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11699 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11700 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11701 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11702 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11703 program, type this on VxWorks:
11704
11705 @smallexample
11706 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11707 @end smallexample
11708
11709 @noindent
11710 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11711
11712 @smallexample
11713 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11714 (vxgdb) load prog.o
11715 @end smallexample
11716
11717 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11718
11719 @smallexample
11720 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11721 @end smallexample
11722
11723 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11724 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11725 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11726 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11727 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11728 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11729 table.)
11730
11731 @node VxWorks Attach
11732 @subsubsection Running tasks
11733
11734 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11735 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11736 follows:
11737
11738 @smallexample
11739 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11740 @end smallexample
11741
11742 @noindent
11743 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11744 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11745 the time of attachment.
11746
11747 @node Embedded Processors
11748 @section Embedded Processors
11749
11750 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11751 configurations.
11752
11753
11754 @menu
11755 * ARM:: ARM
11756 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11757 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11758 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11759 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11760 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11761 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
11762 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11763 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11764 * SH:: Hitachi SH
11765 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11766 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11767 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11768 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11769 @end menu
11770
11771 @node ARM
11772 @subsection ARM
11773
11774 @table @code
11775
11776 @kindex target rdi
11777 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11778 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11779 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11780 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11781
11782 @kindex target rdp
11783 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11784 ARM Demon monitor.
11785
11786 @end table
11787
11788 @node H8/300
11789 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11790
11791 @table @code
11792
11793 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11794 @item target hms @var{dev}
11795 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11796 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11797 line and the communications speed used.
11798
11799 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11800 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11801 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11802
11803 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11804 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11805 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11806 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11807 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11808
11809 @end table
11810
11811 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11812 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11813 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11814 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11815 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11816 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11817 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11818 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11819
11820 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11821 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11822
11823 @enumerate
11824 @item
11825 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11826 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11827 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11828 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11829 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11830
11831 @item
11832 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11833 serial device available on your host is the default).
11834
11835 @item
11836 what speed to use over the serial device.
11837 @end enumerate
11838
11839 @menu
11840 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11841 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11842 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11843 @end menu
11844
11845 @node Hitachi Boards
11846 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11847
11848 @c only for Unix hosts
11849 @kindex device
11850 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11851 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11852 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11853 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11854 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11855
11856 @kindex speed
11857 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11858 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11859 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11860 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11861 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11862 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11863
11864 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11865 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11866 use a DOS host,
11867 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11868 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11869 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11870 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11871
11872 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11873 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11874 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11875 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11876
11877 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11878 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11879 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11880 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11881 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11882 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11883 @code{COM2}.
11884
11885 @smallexample
11886 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11887 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11888
11889 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11890
11891 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11892
11893 @end smallexample
11894
11895 @quotation
11896 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11897 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11898 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11899 your development board.
11900 @end quotation
11901
11902 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11903 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11904 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11905 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11906 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11907 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11908 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11909 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11910 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11911 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11912 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11913 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11914 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11915
11916 @smallexample
11917 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11918 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11919 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11920 the conditions.
11921 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11922 for details.
11923 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11924 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11925 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11926 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11927 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11928 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11929 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11930 @end smallexample
11931
11932 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11933 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11934 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11935 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11936 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11937 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11938
11939 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11940 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11941 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11942
11943 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11944 @itemize @bullet
11945 @item
11946 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11947 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11948
11949 @item
11950 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11951 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11952 to detect program completion.
11953 @end itemize
11954
11955 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11956 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11957
11958 @node Hitachi ICE
11959 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11960
11961 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11962 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11963 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11964 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11965
11966 @table @code
11967 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11968 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11969 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11970 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11971 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11972
11973 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11974 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11975 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11976 @end table
11977
11978 @node Hitachi Special
11979 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11980
11981 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11982
11983 @table @code
11984
11985 @kindex set machine
11986 @kindex show machine
11987 @item set machine h8300
11988 @itemx set machine h8300h
11989 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11990 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11991 to check which variant is currently in effect.
11992
11993 @end table
11994
11995 @node H8/500
11996 @subsection H8/500
11997
11998 @table @code
11999
12000 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
12001 @cindex memory models, H8/500
12002 @item set memory @var{mod}
12003 @itemx show memory
12004 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
12005 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
12006 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
12007 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
12008
12009 @end table
12010
12011 @node M32R/D
12012 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
12013
12014 @table @code
12015
12016 @kindex target m32r
12017 @item target m32r @var{dev}
12018 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
12019
12020 @end table
12021
12022 @node M68K
12023 @subsection M68k
12024
12025 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12026 target command for the following ROM monitors.
12027
12028 @table @code
12029
12030 @kindex target abug
12031 @item target abug @var{dev}
12032 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12033
12034 @kindex target cpu32bug
12035 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12036 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12037
12038 @kindex target dbug
12039 @item target dbug @var{dev}
12040 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12041
12042 @kindex target est
12043 @item target est @var{dev}
12044 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12045
12046 @kindex target rom68k
12047 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
12048 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12049
12050 @end table
12051
12052 @table @code
12053
12054 @kindex target rombug
12055 @item target rombug @var{dev}
12056 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12057
12058 @end table
12059
12060 @node MIPS Embedded
12061 @subsection MIPS Embedded
12062
12063 @cindex MIPS boards
12064 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12065 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12066 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
12067
12068 @need 1000
12069 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
12070
12071 @table @code
12072 @item target mips @var{port}
12073 @kindex target mips @var{port}
12074 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12075 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12076 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12077 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12078 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12079 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
12080
12081 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12082 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12083 debugger:
12084
12085 @smallexample
12086 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
12087 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12088 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12089 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12090 (@value{GDBP}) run
12091 @end smallexample
12092
12093 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12094 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12095 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12096 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12097 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12098
12099 @item target pmon @var{port}
12100 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
12101 PMON ROM monitor.
12102
12103 @item target ddb @var{port}
12104 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
12105 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
12106
12107 @item target lsi @var{port}
12108 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
12109 LSI variant of PMON.
12110
12111 @kindex target r3900
12112 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
12113 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
12114
12115 @kindex target array
12116 @item target array @var{dev}
12117 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
12118
12119 @end table
12120
12121
12122 @noindent
12123 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
12124
12125 @table @code
12126 @item set processor @var{args}
12127 @itemx show processor
12128 @kindex set processor @var{args}
12129 @kindex show processor
12130 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12131 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
12132 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
12133 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
12134 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
12135 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
12136 @value{GDBN} is using.
12137
12138 @item set mipsfpu double
12139 @itemx set mipsfpu single
12140 @itemx set mipsfpu none
12141 @itemx show mipsfpu
12142 @kindex set mipsfpu
12143 @kindex show mipsfpu
12144 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
12145 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12146 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12147 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12148 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12149 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12150 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12151 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12152 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12153 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12154 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12155 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12156 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
12157
12158 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12159 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12160 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12161
12162 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12163 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
12164
12165 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
12166 @itemx show remotedebug
12167 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12168 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12169 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12170 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12171 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12172 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12173 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12174 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12175 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12176 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12177 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12178
12179 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
12180 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12181 @itemx show timeout
12182 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
12183 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12184 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12185 @kindex set timeout
12186 @kindex show timeout
12187 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
12188 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
12189 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12190 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12191 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12192 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12193 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12194 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12195 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12196 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12197
12198 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12199 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12200 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12201 to run before stopping.
12202 @end table
12203
12204 @node OpenRISC 1000
12205 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
12206 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
12207
12208 @cindex or1k boards
12209 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12210 about platform and commands.
12211
12212 @table @code
12213
12214 @kindex target jtag
12215 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12216
12217 Connects to remote JTAG server.
12218 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12219 connected via parallel port to the board.
12220
12221 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12222
12223 @kindex or1ksim
12224 @item or1ksim @var{command}
12225 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12226 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12227
12228 @kindex info or1k spr
12229 @item info or1k spr
12230 Displays spr groups.
12231
12232 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
12233 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12234 Displays register names in selected group.
12235
12236 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12237 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12238 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12239 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12240 Shows information about specified spr register.
12241
12242 @kindex spr
12243 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12244 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12245 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12246 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12247 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12248 @end table
12249
12250 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12251 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12252 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12253 triggers can be set using:
12254 @table @code
12255 @item $LEA/$LDATA
12256 Load effective address/data
12257 @item $SEA/$SDATA
12258 Store effective address/data
12259 @item $AEA/$ADATA
12260 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12261 @item $FETCH
12262 Fetch data
12263 @end table
12264
12265 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12266 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12267
12268 @code{htrace} commands:
12269 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12270 @table @code
12271 @kindex hwatch
12272 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
12273 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12274 or Data. For example:
12275
12276 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12277
12278 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12279
12280 @kindex htrace info
12281 @item htrace info
12282 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12283
12284 @kindex htrace trigger
12285 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12286 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12287
12288 @kindex htrace qualifier
12289 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12290 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12291
12292 @kindex htrace stop
12293 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12294 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12295
12296 @kindex htrace record
12297 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
12298 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12299 triggered.
12300
12301 @kindex htrace enable
12302 @item htrace enable
12303 @kindex htrace disable
12304 @itemx htrace disable
12305 Enables/disables the HW trace.
12306
12307 @kindex htrace rewind
12308 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
12309 Clears currently recorded trace data.
12310
12311 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12312 will be written there.
12313
12314 @kindex htrace print
12315 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
12316 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12317
12318 @kindex htrace mode continuous
12319 @item htrace mode continuous
12320 Set continuous trace mode.
12321
12322 @kindex htrace mode suspend
12323 @item htrace mode suspend
12324 Set suspend trace mode.
12325
12326 @end table
12327
12328 @node PowerPC
12329 @subsection PowerPC
12330
12331 @table @code
12332
12333 @kindex target dink32
12334 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
12335 DINK32 ROM monitor.
12336
12337 @kindex target ppcbug
12338 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12339 @kindex target ppcbug1
12340 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12341 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12342
12343 @kindex target sds
12344 @item target sds @var{dev}
12345 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12346
12347 @end table
12348
12349 @node PA
12350 @subsection HP PA Embedded
12351
12352 @table @code
12353
12354 @kindex target op50n
12355 @item target op50n @var{dev}
12356 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12357
12358 @kindex target w89k
12359 @item target w89k @var{dev}
12360 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12361
12362 @end table
12363
12364 @node SH
12365 @subsection Hitachi SH
12366
12367 @table @code
12368
12369 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12370 @item target hms @var{dev}
12371 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12372 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12373 the communications speed used.
12374
12375 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12376 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
12377 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12378
12379 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12380 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12381 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
12382 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
12383 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12384
12385 @end table
12386
12387 @node Sparclet
12388 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12389
12390 @cindex Sparclet
12391
12392 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12393 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12394 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12395 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12396 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
12397
12398 @table @code
12399 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
12400 @kindex remotetimeout
12401 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12402 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12403 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
12404 @end table
12405
12406 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12407 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12408 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12409 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12410 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
12411
12412 @smallexample
12413 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12414 @end smallexample
12415
12416 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
12417
12418 @smallexample
12419 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12420 @end smallexample
12421
12422 @cindex running, on Sparclet
12423 Once you have set
12424 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12425 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12426 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12427
12428 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12429
12430 @smallexample
12431 (gdbslet)
12432 @end smallexample
12433
12434 @menu
12435 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12436 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12437 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12438 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
12439 @end menu
12440
12441 @node Sparclet File
12442 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
12443
12444 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12445
12446 @smallexample
12447 (gdbslet) file prog
12448 @end smallexample
12449
12450 @need 1000
12451 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12452 @value{GDBN} locates
12453 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12454 path.
12455 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12456 files will be searched as well.
12457 @value{GDBN} locates
12458 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12459 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12460 If it fails
12461 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12462
12463 @smallexample
12464 prog: No such file or directory.
12465 @end smallexample
12466
12467 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12468 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12469 @code{target} command again.
12470
12471 @node Sparclet Connection
12472 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12473
12474 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12475 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12476
12477 @smallexample
12478 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12479 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12480 main () at ../prog.c:3
12481 @end smallexample
12482
12483 @need 750
12484 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12485
12486 @smallexample
12487 Connected to ttya.
12488 @end smallexample
12489
12490 @node Sparclet Download
12491 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12492
12493 @cindex download to Sparclet
12494 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12495 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12496 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12497 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12498 command.
12499 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12500 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12501 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12502 of each of the file's sections.
12503 For instance, if the program
12504 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12505 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12506
12507 @smallexample
12508 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12509 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12510 @end smallexample
12511
12512 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12513 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12514 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12515
12516 @node Sparclet Execution
12517 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12518
12519 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12520 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12521 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12522 manual for the list of commands.
12523
12524 @smallexample
12525 (gdbslet) b main
12526 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12527 (gdbslet) run
12528 Starting program: prog
12529 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12530 3 char *symarg = 0;
12531 (gdbslet) step
12532 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12533 (gdbslet)
12534 @end smallexample
12535
12536 @node Sparclite
12537 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12538
12539 @table @code
12540
12541 @kindex target sparclite
12542 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12543 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12544 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12545 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12546 remote protocol.
12547
12548 @end table
12549
12550 @node ST2000
12551 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12552
12553 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12554 STDBUG protocol.
12555
12556 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12557 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12558
12559 @smallexample
12560 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12561 @end smallexample
12562
12563 @noindent
12564 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12565 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12566 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12567 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12568 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12569
12570 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12571 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12572 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12573 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12574 available on your host computer.
12575 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12576 @c basically hearsay.
12577
12578 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12579 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12580 environment:
12581
12582 @table @code
12583 @item st2000 @var{command}
12584 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12585 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12586 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12587 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12588 manual for available commands.
12589
12590 @item connect
12591 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12592 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12593 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12594 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12595 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12596 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12597 @end table
12598
12599 @node Z8000
12600 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12601
12602 @cindex Z8000
12603 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12604 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12605
12606 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12607 a Z8000 simulator.
12608
12609 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12610 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12611 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12612 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12613
12614 @table @code
12615 @item target sim @var{args}
12616 @kindex sim
12617 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12618 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12619 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12620 @end table
12621
12622 @noindent
12623 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12624 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12625 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12626 to run your program, and so on.
12627
12628 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12629 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12630 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12631
12632 @table @code
12633
12634 @item cycles
12635 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12636
12637 @item insts
12638 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12639
12640 @item time
12641 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12642
12643 @end table
12644
12645 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12646 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12647 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12648 simulated clock ticks.
12649
12650 @node Architectures
12651 @section Architectures
12652
12653 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12654 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12655
12656 @menu
12657 * A29K::
12658 * Alpha::
12659 * MIPS::
12660 @end menu
12661
12662 @node A29K
12663 @subsection A29K
12664
12665 @table @code
12666
12667 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12668 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12669 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12670 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12671 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12672 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12673 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12674 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12675 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12676 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12677 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12678 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12679 hexadecimal.
12680
12681 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12682 @item show rstack_high_address
12683 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12684 processors.
12685
12686 @end table
12687
12688 @node Alpha
12689 @subsection Alpha
12690
12691 See the following section.
12692
12693 @node MIPS
12694 @subsection MIPS
12695
12696 @cindex stack on Alpha
12697 @cindex stack on MIPS
12698 @cindex Alpha stack
12699 @cindex MIPS stack
12700 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12701 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12702 find the beginning of a function.
12703
12704 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12705 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12706 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12707 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12708 commands:
12709
12710 @table @code
12711 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12712 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12713 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12714 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12715 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12716 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12717 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12718
12719 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12720 Display the current limit.
12721 @end table
12722
12723 @noindent
12724 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12725 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12726
12727
12728 @node Controlling GDB
12729 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12730
12731 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12732 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12733 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12734 described here.
12735
12736 @menu
12737 * Prompt:: Prompt
12738 * Editing:: Command editing
12739 * History:: Command history
12740 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12741 * Numbers:: Numbers
12742 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
12743 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12744 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12745 @end menu
12746
12747 @node Prompt
12748 @section Prompt
12749
12750 @cindex prompt
12751
12752 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12753 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12754 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12755 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12756 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12757 which one you are talking to.
12758
12759 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12760 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12761 or a prompt that does not.
12762
12763 @table @code
12764 @kindex set prompt
12765 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12766 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12767
12768 @kindex show prompt
12769 @item show prompt
12770 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12771 @end table
12772
12773 @node Editing
12774 @section Command editing
12775 @cindex readline
12776 @cindex command line editing
12777
12778 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12779 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12780 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12781 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12782 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12783 debugging sessions.
12784
12785 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12786 command @code{set}.
12787
12788 @table @code
12789 @kindex set editing
12790 @cindex editing
12791 @item set editing
12792 @itemx set editing on
12793 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12794
12795 @item set editing off
12796 Disable command line editing.
12797
12798 @kindex show editing
12799 @item show editing
12800 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12801 @end table
12802
12803 @node History
12804 @section Command history
12805
12806 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12807 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12808 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12809 history facility.
12810
12811 @table @code
12812 @cindex history substitution
12813 @cindex history file
12814 @kindex set history filename
12815 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12816 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12817 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12818 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12819 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12820 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12821 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12822 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12823 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12824 is not set.
12825
12826 @cindex history save
12827 @kindex set history save
12828 @item set history save
12829 @itemx set history save on
12830 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12831 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12832
12833 @item set history save off
12834 Stop recording command history in a file.
12835
12836 @cindex history size
12837 @kindex set history size
12838 @item set history size @var{size}
12839 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12840 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12841 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12842 @end table
12843
12844 @cindex history expansion
12845 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12846 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12847 @xref{Event Designators}.
12848 @end ifset
12849
12850 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12851 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12852 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12853 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12854 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12855 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12856 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12857
12858 The commands to control history expansion are:
12859
12860 @table @code
12861 @kindex set history expansion
12862 @item set history expansion on
12863 @itemx set history expansion
12864 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12865
12866 @item set history expansion off
12867 Disable history expansion.
12868
12869 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12870 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12871 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12872 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12873 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12874 @end ifset
12875
12876 @c @group
12877 @kindex show history
12878 @item show history
12879 @itemx show history filename
12880 @itemx show history save
12881 @itemx show history size
12882 @itemx show history expansion
12883 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12884 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12885 @c @end group
12886 @end table
12887
12888 @table @code
12889 @kindex shows
12890 @item show commands
12891 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12892
12893 @item show commands @var{n}
12894 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12895
12896 @item show commands +
12897 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12898 @end table
12899
12900 @node Screen Size
12901 @section Screen size
12902 @cindex size of screen
12903 @cindex pauses in output
12904
12905 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12906 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12907 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12908 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12909 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12910 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12911 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12912 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12913
12914 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12915 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12916 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12917 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12918 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12919 width} commands:
12920
12921 @table @code
12922 @kindex set height
12923 @kindex set width
12924 @kindex show width
12925 @kindex show height
12926 @item set height @var{lpp}
12927 @itemx show height
12928 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12929 @itemx show width
12930 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12931 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12932 commands display the current settings.
12933
12934 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12935 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12936 file or to an editor buffer.
12937
12938 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12939 from wrapping its output.
12940 @end table
12941
12942 @node Numbers
12943 @section Numbers
12944 @cindex number representation
12945 @cindex entering numbers
12946
12947 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12948 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12949 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12950 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12951 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12952 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12953 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12954 radix} command.
12955
12956 @table @code
12957 @kindex set input-radix
12958 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12959 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12960 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12961 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12962 example, any of
12963
12964 @smallexample
12965 set radix 012
12966 set radix 10.
12967 set radix 0xa
12968 @end smallexample
12969
12970 @noindent
12971 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12972 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12973
12974 @kindex set output-radix
12975 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12976 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12977 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12978 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12979
12980 @kindex show input-radix
12981 @item show input-radix
12982 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12983
12984 @kindex show output-radix
12985 @item show output-radix
12986 Display the current default base for numeric display.
12987 @end table
12988
12989 @node ABI
12990 @section Configuring the current ABI
12991
12992 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12993 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12994 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12995 current ABI.
12996
12997 @cindex OS ABI
12998 @kindex set osabi
12999 @kindex show osabi
13000
13001 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
13002 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
13003 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
13004 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
13005 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
13006 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
13007 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
13008 platform provides.
13009
13010 @table @code
13011 @item show osabi
13012 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
13013
13014 @item set osabi
13015 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
13016
13017 @item set osabi @var{abi}
13018 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
13019 @end table
13020
13021 @cindex float promotion
13022 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
13023
13024 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
13025 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
13026 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
13027 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
13028 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
13029 @code{double} and then passed.
13030
13031 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
13032 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
13033 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
13034
13035 @table @code
13036 @item set coerce-float-to-double
13037 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
13038 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
13039 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
13040
13041 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
13042 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
13043 functions.
13044 @end table
13045
13046 @kindex set cp-abi
13047 @kindex show cp-abi
13048 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
13049 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
13050 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
13051 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
13052 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
13053 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
13054 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
13055 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
13056 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
13057 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
13058 ``auto''.
13059
13060 @table @code
13061 @item show cp-abi
13062 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
13063
13064 @item set cp-abi
13065 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
13066
13067 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
13068 @itemx set cp-abi auto
13069 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
13070 @end table
13071
13072 @node Messages/Warnings
13073 @section Optional warnings and messages
13074
13075 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
13076 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
13077 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
13078 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
13079
13080 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
13081 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
13082 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
13083
13084 @table @code
13085 @kindex set verbose
13086 @item set verbose on
13087 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13088
13089 @item set verbose off
13090 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13091
13092 @kindex show verbose
13093 @item show verbose
13094 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
13095 @end table
13096
13097 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
13098 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
13099 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
13100 symbol files}).
13101
13102 @table @code
13103
13104 @kindex set complaints
13105 @item set complaints @var{limit}
13106 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
13107 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
13108 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
13109 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
13110
13111 @kindex show complaints
13112 @item show complaints
13113 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
13114
13115 @end table
13116
13117 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
13118 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
13119 you try to run a program which is already running:
13120
13121 @smallexample
13122 (@value{GDBP}) run
13123 The program being debugged has been started already.
13124 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
13125 @end smallexample
13126
13127 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
13128 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
13129
13130 @table @code
13131
13132 @kindex set confirm
13133 @cindex flinching
13134 @cindex confirmation
13135 @cindex stupid questions
13136 @item set confirm off
13137 Disables confirmation requests.
13138
13139 @item set confirm on
13140 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
13141
13142 @kindex show confirm
13143 @item show confirm
13144 Displays state of confirmation requests.
13145
13146 @end table
13147
13148 @node Debugging Output
13149 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
13150 @table @code
13151 @kindex set debug arch
13152 @item set debug arch
13153 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
13154 @kindex show debug arch
13155 @item show debug arch
13156 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
13157 @kindex set debug event
13158 @item set debug event
13159 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
13160 default is off.
13161 @kindex show debug event
13162 @item show debug event
13163 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
13164 info.
13165 @kindex set debug expression
13166 @item set debug expression
13167 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
13168 default is off.
13169 @kindex show debug expression
13170 @item show debug expression
13171 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13172 debugging info.
13173 @kindex set debug frame
13174 @item set debug frame
13175 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
13176 default is off.
13177 @kindex show debug frame
13178 @item show debug frame
13179 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
13180 info.
13181 @kindex set debug overload
13182 @item set debug overload
13183 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13184 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13185 is off.
13186 @kindex show debug overload
13187 @item show debug overload
13188 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13189 debugging info.
13190 @kindex set debug remote
13191 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13192 @cindex serial connections, debugging
13193 @item set debug remote
13194 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13195 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13196 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13197 @kindex show debug remote
13198 @item show debug remote
13199 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13200 @kindex set debug serial
13201 @item set debug serial
13202 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13203 default is off.
13204 @kindex show debug serial
13205 @item show debug serial
13206 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13207 info.
13208 @kindex set debug target
13209 @item set debug target
13210 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13211 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13212 default is off.
13213 @kindex show debug target
13214 @item show debug target
13215 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13216 info.
13217 @kindex set debug varobj
13218 @item set debug varobj
13219 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13220 info. The default is off.
13221 @kindex show debug varobj
13222 @item show debug varobj
13223 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13224 debugging info.
13225 @end table
13226
13227 @node Sequences
13228 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
13229
13230 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13231 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13232 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13233 files.
13234
13235 @menu
13236 * Define:: User-defined commands
13237 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13238 * Command Files:: Command files
13239 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
13240 @end menu
13241
13242 @node Define
13243 @section User-defined commands
13244
13245 @cindex user-defined command
13246 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13247 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13248 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13249 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13250 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
13251
13252 @smallexample
13253 define adder
13254 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13255 @end smallexample
13256
13257 @noindent
13258 To execute the command use:
13259
13260 @smallexample
13261 adder 1 2 3
13262 @end smallexample
13263
13264 @noindent
13265 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13266 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13267 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13268 functions calls.
13269
13270 @table @code
13271
13272 @kindex define
13273 @item define @var{commandname}
13274 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13275 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
13276
13277 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13278 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13279 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13280
13281 @kindex if
13282 @kindex else
13283 @item if
13284 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13285 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13286 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13287 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13288 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13289 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13290
13291 @kindex while
13292 @item while
13293 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13294 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13295 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13296 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13297 evaluates to true.
13298
13299 @kindex document
13300 @item document @var{commandname}
13301 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13302 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13303 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13304 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13305 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13306 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
13307
13308 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13309 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13310 does not change the documentation.
13311
13312 @kindex help user-defined
13313 @item help user-defined
13314 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13315 (if any) for each.
13316
13317 @kindex show user
13318 @item show user
13319 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
13320 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13321 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13322 definitions for all user-defined commands.
13323
13324 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
13325 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
13326 @item show max-user-call-depth
13327 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
13328 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13329 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13330 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
13331
13332 @end table
13333
13334 When user-defined commands are executed, the
13335 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13336 stops execution of the user-defined command.
13337
13338 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13339 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13340 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13341 messages when used in a user-defined command.
13342
13343 @node Hooks
13344 @section User-defined command hooks
13345 @cindex command hooks
13346 @cindex hooks, for commands
13347 @cindex hooks, pre-command
13348
13349 @kindex hook
13350 @kindex hook-
13351 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13352 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13353 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13354 before that command.
13355
13356 @cindex hooks, post-command
13357 @kindex hookpost
13358 @kindex hookpost-
13359 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13360 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13361 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13362 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13363 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
13364
13365 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13366 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
13367
13368 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13369 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13370
13371 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13372 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13373 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13374 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13375 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13376
13377 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13378 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13379 you could define:
13380
13381 @smallexample
13382 define hook-stop
13383 handle SIGALRM nopass
13384 end
13385
13386 define hook-run
13387 handle SIGALRM pass
13388 end
13389
13390 define hook-continue
13391 handle SIGLARM pass
13392 end
13393 @end smallexample
13394
13395 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13396 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13397 you could define:
13398
13399 @smallexample
13400 define hook-echo
13401 echo <<<---
13402 end
13403
13404 define hookpost-echo
13405 echo --->>>\n
13406 end
13407
13408 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13409 <<<---Hello World--->>>
13410 (@value{GDBP})
13411
13412 @end smallexample
13413
13414 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13415 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13416 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13417 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13418 @c or not?
13419 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13420 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13421 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13422
13423 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13424 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13425
13426 @node Command Files
13427 @section Command files
13428
13429 @cindex command files
13430 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13431 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13432 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13433 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13434
13435 @cindex init file
13436 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13437 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13438 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13439 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13440 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13441 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13442 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
13443
13444 @enumerate
13445 @item
13446 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13447 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13448 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13449
13450 @item
13451 Processes command line options and operands.
13452
13453 @item
13454 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13455
13456 @item
13457 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13458 @end enumerate
13459
13460 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13461 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13462 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13463 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
13464
13465 @cindex init file name
13466 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13467 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13468 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13469 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13470 environments with special init file names:
13471
13472 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13473 @itemize @bullet
13474 @item
13475 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
13476
13477 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13478 @item
13479 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
13480
13481 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13482 @item
13483 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13484 @end itemize
13485
13486 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13487 @code{source} command:
13488
13489 @table @code
13490 @kindex source
13491 @item source @var{filename}
13492 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13493 @end table
13494
13495 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13496 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13497 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
13498
13499 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13500 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13501 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13502 when called from command files.
13503
13504 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13505 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13506 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13507 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13508 the next command.
13509
13510 @smallexample
13511 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13512 @end smallexample
13513
13514 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13515 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13516 would be directed to @file{log}.
13517
13518 @node Output
13519 @section Commands for controlled output
13520
13521 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13522 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13523 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13524 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13525 want.
13526
13527 @table @code
13528 @kindex echo
13529 @item echo @var{text}
13530 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13531 @c because it is not in ANSI.
13532 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13533 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13534 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13535 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13536 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13537 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13538 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13539 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13540 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13541
13542 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13543 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13544
13545 @smallexample
13546 echo This is some text\n\
13547 which is continued\n\
13548 onto several lines.\n
13549 @end smallexample
13550
13551 produces the same output as
13552
13553 @smallexample
13554 echo This is some text\n
13555 echo which is continued\n
13556 echo onto several lines.\n
13557 @end smallexample
13558
13559 @kindex output
13560 @item output @var{expression}
13561 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13562 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13563 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13564 on expressions.
13565
13566 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13567 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13568 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13569 formats}, for more information.
13570
13571 @kindex printf
13572 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13573 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13574 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13575 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13576 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13577 subroutine
13578 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13579 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13580 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13581 @c supported.
13582
13583 @smallexample
13584 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13585 @end smallexample
13586
13587 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13588
13589 @smallexample
13590 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13591 @end smallexample
13592
13593 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13594 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13595 letter.
13596 @end table
13597
13598 @node Interpreters
13599 @chapter Command Interpreters
13600 @cindex command interpreters
13601
13602 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13603 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13604 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13605
13606 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13607 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13608 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13609 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13610
13611 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13612 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13613 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13614 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13615
13616 @table @code
13617 @item console
13618 @cindex console interpreter
13619 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13620 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13621 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13622
13623 @item mi
13624 @cindex mi interpreter
13625 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13626 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13627 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13628 Interface}.
13629
13630 @item mi2
13631 @cindex mi2 interpreter
13632 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13633
13634 @item mi1
13635 @cindex mi1 interpreter
13636 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13637
13638 @end table
13639
13640 @cindex invoke another interpreter
13641 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13642 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13643 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13644 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13645 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13646 the IDE inoperable!
13647
13648 @kindex interpreter-exec
13649 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13650 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13651 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13652 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
13653
13654 @smallexample
13655 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13656 @end smallexample
13657
13658 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13659 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13660
13661 @node TUI
13662 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13663 @cindex TUI
13664
13665 @menu
13666 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13667 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13668 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
13669 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13670 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13671 @end menu
13672
13673 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13674 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13675 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13676 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13677 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13678 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13679
13680 @node TUI Overview
13681 @section TUI overview
13682
13683 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13684 @value{GDBN} runs:
13685
13686 @itemize @bullet
13687 @item
13688 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13689 windows on the terminal.
13690
13691 @item
13692 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13693 the TUI.
13694 @end itemize
13695
13696 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13697 on the terminal:
13698
13699 @table @emph
13700 @item command
13701 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13702 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13703 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13704 window is always visible.
13705
13706 @item source
13707 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13708 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13709
13710 @item assembly
13711 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13712
13713 @item register
13714 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13715 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13716 changed are highlighted.
13717
13718 @end table
13719
13720 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13721 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13722 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13723 indicates the breakpoint type:
13724
13725 @table @code
13726 @item B
13727 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13728
13729 @item b
13730 Breakpoint which was never hit.
13731
13732 @item H
13733 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13734
13735 @item h
13736 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13737
13738 @end table
13739
13740 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13741
13742 @table @code
13743 @item +
13744 Breakpoint is enabled.
13745
13746 @item -
13747 Breakpoint is disabled.
13748
13749 @end table
13750
13751 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13752 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13753 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13754 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13755 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13756 The following layouts are available:
13757
13758 @itemize @bullet
13759 @item
13760 source
13761
13762 @item
13763 assembly
13764
13765 @item
13766 source and assembly
13767
13768 @item
13769 source and registers
13770
13771 @item
13772 assembly and registers
13773
13774 @end itemize
13775
13776 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13777 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13778 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13779 are displayed:
13780
13781 @table @emph
13782 @item target
13783 Indicates the current gdb target
13784 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13785
13786 @item process
13787 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13788 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13789
13790 @item function
13791 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13792 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13793 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13794 the string @code{??} is displayed.
13795
13796 @item line
13797 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13798 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13799
13800 @item pc
13801 Indicates the current program counter address.
13802
13803 @end table
13804
13805 @node TUI Keys
13806 @section TUI Key Bindings
13807 @cindex TUI key bindings
13808
13809 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13810 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13811 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13812 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13813 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13814 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
13815 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13816
13817 @table @kbd
13818 @kindex C-x C-a
13819 @item C-x C-a
13820 @kindex C-x a
13821 @itemx C-x a
13822 @kindex C-x A
13823 @itemx C-x A
13824 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13825 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13826 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13827 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13828 The screen is then refreshed.
13829
13830 @kindex C-x 1
13831 @item C-x 1
13832 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13833 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13834 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13835
13836 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13837
13838 @kindex C-x 2
13839 @item C-x 2
13840 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13841 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13842 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13843 previous layout and the new one.
13844
13845 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13846
13847 @kindex C-x s
13848 @item C-x s
13849 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13850 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13851
13852 @end table
13853
13854 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13855
13856 @table @key
13857 @kindex PgUp
13858 @item PgUp
13859 Scroll the active window one page up.
13860
13861 @kindex PgDn
13862 @item PgDn
13863 Scroll the active window one page down.
13864
13865 @kindex Up
13866 @item Up
13867 Scroll the active window one line up.
13868
13869 @kindex Down
13870 @item Down
13871 Scroll the active window one line down.
13872
13873 @kindex Left
13874 @item Left
13875 Scroll the active window one column left.
13876
13877 @kindex Right
13878 @item Right
13879 Scroll the active window one column right.
13880
13881 @kindex C-L
13882 @item C-L
13883 Refresh the screen.
13884
13885 @end table
13886
13887 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13888 for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13889 necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13890 @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13891
13892 @node TUI Single Key Mode
13893 @section TUI Single Key Mode
13894 @cindex TUI single key mode
13895
13896 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13897 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13898 some gdb commands.
13899
13900 @table @kbd
13901 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13902 @item c
13903 continue
13904
13905 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13906 @item d
13907 down
13908
13909 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13910 @item f
13911 finish
13912
13913 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13914 @item n
13915 next
13916
13917 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13918 @item q
13919 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13920
13921 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13922 @item r
13923 run
13924
13925 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13926 @item s
13927 step
13928
13929 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13930 @item u
13931 up
13932
13933 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13934 @item v
13935 info locals
13936
13937 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13938 @item w
13939 where
13940
13941 @end table
13942
13943 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13944 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13945 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13946 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13947 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13948 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13949
13950
13951 @node TUI Commands
13952 @section TUI specific commands
13953 @cindex TUI commands
13954
13955 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13956 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13957 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13958 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13959 in the TUI mode.
13960
13961 @table @code
13962 @item info win
13963 @kindex info win
13964 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13965
13966 @item layout next
13967 @kindex layout next
13968 Display the next layout.
13969
13970 @item layout prev
13971 @kindex layout prev
13972 Display the previous layout.
13973
13974 @item layout src
13975 @kindex layout src
13976 Display the source window only.
13977
13978 @item layout asm
13979 @kindex layout asm
13980 Display the assembly window only.
13981
13982 @item layout split
13983 @kindex layout split
13984 Display the source and assembly window.
13985
13986 @item layout regs
13987 @kindex layout regs
13988 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13989
13990 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13991 @kindex focus
13992 Set the focus to the named window.
13993 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13994 can be affected to another window.
13995
13996 @item refresh
13997 @kindex refresh
13998 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13999
14000 @item update
14001 @kindex update
14002 Update the source window and the current execution point.
14003
14004 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
14005 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
14006 @kindex winheight
14007 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
14008 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
14009 decrease it.
14010
14011 @end table
14012
14013 @node TUI Configuration
14014 @section TUI configuration variables
14015 @cindex TUI configuration variables
14016
14017 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
14018 appearance of windows on the terminal.
14019
14020 @table @code
14021 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
14022 @kindex set tui border-kind
14023 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
14024 The possible values are the following:
14025 @table @code
14026 @item space
14027 Use a space character to draw the border.
14028
14029 @item ascii
14030 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
14031
14032 @item acs
14033 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
14034 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
14035
14036 @end table
14037
14038 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
14039 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
14040 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
14041 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
14042 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
14043
14044 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
14045 @kindex set tui border-mode
14046 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
14047 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
14048 @table @code
14049 @item normal
14050 Use normal attributes to display the border.
14051
14052 @item standout
14053 Use standout mode.
14054
14055 @item reverse
14056 Use reverse video mode.
14057
14058 @item half
14059 Use half bright mode.
14060
14061 @item half-standout
14062 Use half bright and standout mode.
14063
14064 @item bold
14065 Use extra bright or bold mode.
14066
14067 @item bold-standout
14068 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
14069
14070 @end table
14071
14072 @end table
14073
14074 @node Emacs
14075 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
14076
14077 @cindex Emacs
14078 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
14079 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
14080 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
14081 @value{GDBN}.
14082
14083 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
14084 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
14085 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
14086 created Emacs buffer.
14087 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
14088
14089 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
14090 things:
14091
14092 @itemize @bullet
14093 @item
14094 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
14095 @end itemize
14096
14097 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
14098 and output done by the program you are debugging.
14099
14100 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
14101 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
14102 in this way.
14103
14104 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
14105 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
14106 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
14107 stop.
14108
14109 @itemize @bullet
14110 @item
14111 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
14112 @end itemize
14113
14114 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
14115 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
14116 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
14117 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
14118 and the source.
14119
14120 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
14121 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
14122
14123 @quotation
14124 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
14125 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
14126 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
14127 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
14128 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
14129 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
14130 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
14131 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
14132 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
14133 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
14134
14135 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
14136 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
14137 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
14138 @end quotation
14139
14140 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
14141 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
14142 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
14143 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
14144
14145 @smallexample
14146 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
14147 @end smallexample
14148
14149 @noindent
14150 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
14151 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
14152 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
14153
14154 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
14155 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
14156
14157 @table @kbd
14158 @item C-h m
14159 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
14160
14161 @item M-s
14162 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
14163 update the display window to show the current file and location.
14164
14165 @item M-n
14166 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
14167 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
14168 to show the current file and location.
14169
14170 @item M-i
14171 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
14172 display window accordingly.
14173
14174 @item M-x gdb-nexti
14175 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
14176 display window accordingly.
14177
14178 @item C-c C-f
14179 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
14180 @code{finish} command.
14181
14182 @item M-c
14183 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
14184 command.
14185
14186 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
14187
14188 @item M-u
14189 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
14190 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
14191 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
14192
14193 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
14194
14195 @item M-d
14196 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14197 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
14198
14199 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
14200
14201 @item C-x &
14202 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
14203 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
14204 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
14205 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
14206 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
14207
14208 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
14209 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
14210 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
14211 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
14212 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
14213 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
14214 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
14215 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
14216 @end table
14217
14218 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
14219 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
14220
14221 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14222 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14223 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14224 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14225 frame.
14226
14227 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14228 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14229 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14230 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14231 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14232 to correspond properly with the code.
14233
14234 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14235 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14236 @ignore
14237 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14238 @kindex Epoch
14239 @kindex inspect
14240
14241 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14242 called the @code{epoch}
14243 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14244 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14245 each value is printed in its own window.
14246 @end ignore
14247
14248
14249 @node GDB/MI
14250 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
14251
14252 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
14253
14254 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
14255 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to @value{GDBN}. It is
14256 specifically intended to support the development of systems which use
14257 the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
14258
14259 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
14260 in the form of a reference manual.
14261
14262 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
14263 features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
14264
14265 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
14266
14267 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
14268 This chapter uses the following notation:
14269
14270 @itemize @bullet
14271 @item
14272 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
14273
14274 @item
14275 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
14276 it may or may not be given.
14277
14278 @item
14279 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14280 may repeat zero or more times.
14281
14282 @item
14283 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14284 may repeat one or more times.
14285
14286 @item
14287 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
14288 @end itemize
14289
14290 @ignore
14291 @heading Dependencies
14292 @end ignore
14293
14294 @heading Acknowledgments
14295
14296 In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
14297 Elena Zannoni.
14298
14299 @menu
14300 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
14301 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
14302 * GDB/MI Output Records::
14303 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
14304 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
14305 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
14306 * GDB/MI Program Control::
14307 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
14308 @ignore
14309 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
14310 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
14311 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
14312 @end ignore
14313 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
14314 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
14315 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
14316 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
14317 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
14318 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
14319 @end menu
14320
14321 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14322 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
14323 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
14324
14325 @menu
14326 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
14327 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
14328 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
14329 @end menu
14330
14331 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
14332 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
14333
14334 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
14335 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
14336 @table @code
14337 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
14338 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
14339
14340 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
14341 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
14342 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14343
14344 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
14345 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
14346 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
14347
14348 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14349 "any sequence of digits"
14350
14351 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
14352 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
14353
14354 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
14355 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
14356
14357 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
14358 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
14359
14360 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
14361 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
14362 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
14363
14364 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
14365 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
14366
14367 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14368 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14369 @end table
14370
14371 @noindent
14372 Notes:
14373
14374 @itemize @bullet
14375 @item
14376 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
14377 output is described below.
14378
14379 @item
14380 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
14381 finishes.
14382
14383 @item
14384 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
14385 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
14386 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
14387 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
14388 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
14389 @end itemize
14390
14391 Pragmatics:
14392
14393 @itemize @bullet
14394 @item
14395 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
14396
14397 @item
14398 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
14399 @end itemize
14400
14401 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
14402 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
14403
14404 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
14405 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
14406 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
14407 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
14408 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
14409 terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
14410
14411 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
14412 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
14413 @var{token}.
14414
14415 @table @code
14416 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
14417 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
14418
14419 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
14420 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14421
14422 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
14423 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
14424
14425 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
14426 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
14427
14428 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
14429 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
14430
14431 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
14432 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
14433
14434 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
14435 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
14436
14437 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
14438 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14439
14440 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
14441 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
14442
14443 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
14444 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
14445 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
14446
14447 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
14448 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
14449
14450 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
14451 @code{ @var{string} }
14452
14453 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
14454 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
14455
14456 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
14457 @code{@var{c-string}}
14458
14459 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
14460 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
14461
14462 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
14463 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
14464 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
14465
14466 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
14467 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
14468
14469 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
14470 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
14471
14472 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
14473 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
14474
14475 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
14476 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
14477
14478 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14479 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14480
14481 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14482 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
14483 @end table
14484
14485 @noindent
14486 Notes:
14487
14488 @itemize @bullet
14489 @item
14490 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
14491
14492 @item
14493 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
14494 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
14495 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
14496 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
14497
14498 @item
14499 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14500 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
14501 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
14502 prefixed by @samp{+}.
14503
14504 @item
14505 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14506 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
14507 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
14508 @samp{*}.
14509
14510 @item
14511 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14512 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
14513 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
14514 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
14515
14516 @item
14517 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14518 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
14519 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
14520 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
14521
14522 @item
14523 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14524 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
14525 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
14526
14527 @item
14528 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14529 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
14530 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
14531 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
14532
14533 @item
14534 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14535 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
14536 @var{values}.
14537
14538
14539 @end itemize
14540
14541 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
14542 details about the various output records.
14543
14544 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
14545 @subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
14546 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
14547
14548 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
14549 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
14550 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
14551 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
14552
14553 @subsubheading Target Stop
14554 @c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
14555 Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
14556
14557 @smallexample
14558 -> -stop
14559 <- (@value{GDBP})
14560 @end smallexample
14561
14562 @noindent
14563 and later:
14564
14565 @smallexample
14566 <- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14567 <- (@value{GDBP})
14568 @end smallexample
14569
14570 @subsubheading Simple CLI Command
14571
14572 Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
14573 @sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
14574
14575 @smallexample
14576 -> print 1+2
14577 <- &"print 1+2\n"
14578 <- ~"$1 = 3\n"
14579 <- ^done
14580 <- (@value{GDBP})
14581 @end smallexample
14582
14583 @subsubheading Command With Side Effects
14584
14585 @smallexample
14586 -> -symbol-file xyz.exe
14587 <- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14588 <- (@value{GDBP})
14589 @end smallexample
14590
14591 @subsubheading A Bad Command
14592
14593 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
14594
14595 @smallexample
14596 -> -rubbish
14597 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
14598 <- (@value{GDBP})
14599 @end smallexample
14600
14601 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14602 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
14603 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
14604
14605 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
14606 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
14607 To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
14608 accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
14609 commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
14610 respond.
14611
14612 This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
14613 clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
14614 is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
14615 behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
14616 an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
14617
14618 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14619 @node GDB/MI Output Records
14620 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
14621
14622 @menu
14623 * GDB/MI Result Records::
14624 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
14625 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
14626 @end menu
14627
14628 @node GDB/MI Result Records
14629 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
14630
14631 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14632 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
14633 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
14634 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
14635
14636 @table @code
14637 @findex ^done
14638 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
14639 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
14640 values.
14641
14642 @item "^running"
14643 @findex ^running
14644 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
14645 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
14646 running.
14647
14648 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
14649 @findex ^error
14650 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
14651 error message.
14652 @end table
14653
14654 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
14655 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
14656
14657 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
14658 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14659 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
14660 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
14661 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
14662
14663 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
14664 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
14665 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
14666 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
14667 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
14668
14669 @table @code
14670 @item "~" @var{string-output}
14671 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
14672 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
14673
14674 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
14675 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
14676 target.
14677
14678 @item "&" @var{string-output}
14679 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
14680 internals.
14681 @end table
14682
14683 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
14684 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
14685
14686 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14687 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
14688 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
14689 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
14690 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
14691 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
14692
14693 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
14694
14695 @table @code
14696 @item "*" "stop"
14697 @end table
14698
14699
14700 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14701 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
14702 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
14703
14704 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
14705 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
14706
14707 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
14708 readability. They don't appear in the real output.
14709 Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
14710 not yet implemented.
14711
14712 @subheading Motivation
14713
14714 The motivation for this collection of commands.
14715
14716 @subheading Introduction
14717
14718 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
14719
14720 @subheading Commands
14721
14722 For each command in the block, the following is described:
14723
14724 @subsubheading Synopsis
14725
14726 @smallexample
14727 -command @var{args}@dots{}
14728 @end smallexample
14729
14730 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14731
14732 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14733
14734 @subsubheading Result
14735
14736 @subsubheading Out-of-band
14737
14738 @subsubheading Notes
14739
14740 @subsubheading Example
14741
14742
14743 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14744 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
14745 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
14746
14747 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
14748 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
14749 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
14750 breakpoints.
14751
14752 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
14753 @findex -break-after
14754
14755 @subsubheading Synopsis
14756
14757 @smallexample
14758 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
14759 @end smallexample
14760
14761 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
14762 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
14763 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
14764 @samp{-break-list} command below.
14765
14766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14767
14768 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
14769
14770 @subsubheading Example
14771
14772 @smallexample
14773 (@value{GDBP})
14774 -break-insert main
14775 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
14776 (@value{GDBP})
14777 -break-after 1 3
14778 ~
14779 ^done
14780 (@value{GDBP})
14781 -break-list
14782 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14783 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14784 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14785 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14786 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14787 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14788 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14789 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14790 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
14791 ignore="3"@}]@}
14792 (@value{GDBP})
14793 @end smallexample
14794
14795 @ignore
14796 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
14797 @findex -break-catch
14798
14799 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
14800 @findex -break-commands
14801 @end ignore
14802
14803
14804 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
14805 @findex -break-condition
14806
14807 @subsubheading Synopsis
14808
14809 @smallexample
14810 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
14811 @end smallexample
14812
14813 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
14814 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
14815 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
14816 command below).
14817
14818 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14819
14820 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
14821
14822 @subsubheading Example
14823
14824 @smallexample
14825 (@value{GDBP})
14826 -break-condition 1 1
14827 ^done
14828 (@value{GDBP})
14829 -break-list
14830 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14831 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14832 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14833 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14834 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14835 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14836 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14837 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14838 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
14839 times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
14840 (@value{GDBP})
14841 @end smallexample
14842
14843 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
14844 @findex -break-delete
14845
14846 @subsubheading Synopsis
14847
14848 @smallexample
14849 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14850 @end smallexample
14851
14852 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
14853 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
14854
14855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14856
14857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
14858
14859 @subsubheading Example
14860
14861 @smallexample
14862 (@value{GDBP})
14863 -break-delete 1
14864 ^done
14865 (@value{GDBP})
14866 -break-list
14867 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14868 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14869 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14870 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14871 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14872 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14873 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14874 body=[]@}
14875 (@value{GDBP})
14876 @end smallexample
14877
14878 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
14879 @findex -break-disable
14880
14881 @subsubheading Synopsis
14882
14883 @smallexample
14884 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14885 @end smallexample
14886
14887 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
14888 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
14889
14890 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14891
14892 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
14893
14894 @subsubheading Example
14895
14896 @smallexample
14897 (@value{GDBP})
14898 -break-disable 2
14899 ^done
14900 (@value{GDBP})
14901 -break-list
14902 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14903 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14904 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14905 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14906 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14907 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14908 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14909 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
14910 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14911 (@value{GDBP})
14912 @end smallexample
14913
14914 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
14915 @findex -break-enable
14916
14917 @subsubheading Synopsis
14918
14919 @smallexample
14920 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14921 @end smallexample
14922
14923 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
14924
14925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14926
14927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
14928
14929 @subsubheading Example
14930
14931 @smallexample
14932 (@value{GDBP})
14933 -break-enable 2
14934 ^done
14935 (@value{GDBP})
14936 -break-list
14937 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14938 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14939 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14940 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14941 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14942 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14943 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14944 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14945 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14946 (@value{GDBP})
14947 @end smallexample
14948
14949 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
14950 @findex -break-info
14951
14952 @subsubheading Synopsis
14953
14954 @smallexample
14955 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
14956 @end smallexample
14957
14958 @c REDUNDANT???
14959 Get information about a single breakpoint.
14960
14961 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14962
14963 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
14964
14965 @subsubheading Example
14966 N.A.
14967
14968 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
14969 @findex -break-insert
14970
14971 @subsubheading Synopsis
14972
14973 @smallexample
14974 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
14975 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
14976 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
14977 @end smallexample
14978
14979 @noindent
14980 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
14981
14982 @itemize @bullet
14983 @item function
14984 @c @item +offset
14985 @c @item -offset
14986 @c @item linenum
14987 @item filename:linenum
14988 @item filename:function
14989 @item *address
14990 @end itemize
14991
14992 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
14993
14994 @table @samp
14995 @item -t
14996 Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
14997 @item -h
14998 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
14999 @item -c @var{condition}
15000 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
15001 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
15002 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
15003 @item -r
15004 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
15005 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
15006 expresson.
15007 @end table
15008
15009 @subsubheading Result
15010
15011 The result is in the form:
15012
15013 @smallexample
15014 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
15015 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
15016 @end smallexample
15017
15018 @noindent
15019 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
15020 is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
15021 @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
15022 function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
15023
15024 Note: this format is open to change.
15025 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
15026
15027 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15028
15029 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
15030 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
15031
15032 @subsubheading Example
15033
15034 @smallexample
15035 (@value{GDBP})
15036 -break-insert main
15037 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
15038 (@value{GDBP})
15039 -break-insert -t foo
15040 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15041 (@value{GDBP})
15042 -break-list
15043 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15044 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15045 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15046 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15047 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15048 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15049 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15050 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15051 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
15052 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
15053 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
15054 (@value{GDBP})
15055 -break-insert -r foo.*
15056 ~int foo(int, int);
15057 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15058 (@value{GDBP})
15059 @end smallexample
15060
15061 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
15062 @findex -break-list
15063
15064 @subsubheading Synopsis
15065
15066 @smallexample
15067 -break-list
15068 @end smallexample
15069
15070 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
15071
15072 @table @samp
15073 @item Number
15074 number of the breakpoint
15075 @item Type
15076 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
15077 @item Disposition
15078 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
15079 or @samp{nokeep}
15080 @item Enabled
15081 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
15082 @item Address
15083 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
15084 @item What
15085 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
15086 name, line number
15087 @item Times
15088 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
15089 @end table
15090
15091 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
15092 @code{body} field is an empty list.
15093
15094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15095
15096 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
15097
15098 @subsubheading Example
15099
15100 @smallexample
15101 (@value{GDBP})
15102 -break-list
15103 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15104 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15105 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15106 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15107 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15108 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15109 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15110 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15111 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
15112 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15113 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
15114 (@value{GDBP})
15115 @end smallexample
15116
15117 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
15118
15119 @smallexample
15120 (@value{GDBP})
15121 -break-list
15122 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
15123 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15124 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15125 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15126 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15127 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15128 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15129 body=[]@}
15130 (@value{GDBP})
15131 @end smallexample
15132
15133 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
15134 @findex -break-watch
15135
15136 @subsubheading Synopsis
15137
15138 @smallexample
15139 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
15140 @end smallexample
15141
15142 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
15143 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
15144 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
15145 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
15146 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
15147 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
15148 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
15149 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
15150
15151 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
15152 breakpoints inserted.
15153
15154 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15155
15156 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
15157 @samp{rwatch}.
15158
15159 @subsubheading Example
15160
15161 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
15162
15163 @smallexample
15164 (@value{GDBP})
15165 -break-watch x
15166 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
15167 (@value{GDBP})
15168 -exec-continue
15169 ^running
15170 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
15171 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
15172 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="5"@}
15173 (@value{GDBP})
15174 @end smallexample
15175
15176 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
15177 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
15178 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
15179
15180 @smallexample
15181 (@value{GDBP})
15182 -break-watch C
15183 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
15184 (@value{GDBP})
15185 -exec-continue
15186 ^running
15187 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
15188 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15189 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15190 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15191 (@value{GDBP})
15192 -exec-continue
15193 ^running
15194 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
15195 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15196 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15197 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15198 (@value{GDBP})
15199 @end smallexample
15200
15201 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
15202 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
15203 deleted.
15204
15205 @smallexample
15206 (@value{GDBP})
15207 -break-watch C
15208 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
15209 (@value{GDBP})
15210 -break-list
15211 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15212 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15213 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15214 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15215 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15216 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15217 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15218 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15219 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15220 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15221 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15222 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
15223 (@value{GDBP})
15224 -exec-continue
15225 ^running
15226 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
15227 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15228 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15229 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15230 (@value{GDBP})
15231 -break-list
15232 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15233 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15234 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15235 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15236 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15237 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15238 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15239 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15240 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15241 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15242 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15243 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
15244 (@value{GDBP})
15245 -exec-continue
15246 ^running
15247 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
15248 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15249 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15250 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15251 (@value{GDBP})
15252 -break-list
15253 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15254 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15255 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15256 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15257 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15258 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15259 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15260 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15261 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15262 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
15263 (@value{GDBP})
15264 @end smallexample
15265
15266 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15267 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
15268 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
15269
15270 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
15271 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
15272 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
15273 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
15274
15275 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
15276 @c @subheading -data-assign
15277 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
15278 @c @subsubheading GDB command
15279 @c set variable
15280 @c @subsubheading Example
15281 @c N.A.
15282
15283 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
15284 @findex -data-disassemble
15285
15286 @subsubheading Synopsis
15287
15288 @smallexample
15289 -data-disassemble
15290 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
15291 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
15292 -- @var{mode}
15293 @end smallexample
15294
15295 @noindent
15296 Where:
15297
15298 @table @samp
15299 @item @var{start-addr}
15300 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
15301 @item @var{end-addr}
15302 is the end address
15303 @item @var{filename}
15304 is the name of the file to disassemble
15305 @item @var{linenum}
15306 is the line number to disassemble around
15307 @item @var{lines}
15308 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
15309 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
15310 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
15311 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
15312 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
15313 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
15314 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
15315 are displayed.
15316 @item @var{mode}
15317 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
15318 disassembly).
15319 @end table
15320
15321 @subsubheading Result
15322
15323 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
15324
15325 @itemize @bullet
15326 @item Address
15327 @item Func-name
15328 @item Offset
15329 @item Instruction
15330 @end itemize
15331
15332 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
15333 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
15334
15335 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15336
15337 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
15338
15339 @subsubheading Example
15340
15341 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
15342
15343 @smallexample
15344 (@value{GDBP})
15345 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
15346 ^done,
15347 asm_insns=[
15348 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15349 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15350 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15351 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15352 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
15353 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
15354 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
15355 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15356 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
15357 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
15358 (@value{GDBP})
15359 @end smallexample
15360
15361 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
15362 @code{main}.
15363
15364 @smallexample
15365 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
15366 ^done,asm_insns=[
15367 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15368 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15369 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15370 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15371 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15372 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15373 [@dots{}]
15374 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
15375 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
15376 (@value{GDBP})
15377 @end smallexample
15378
15379 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
15380
15381 @smallexample
15382 (@value{GDBP})
15383 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
15384 ^done,asm_insns=[
15385 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15386 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15387 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15388 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15389 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15390 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
15391 (@value{GDBP})
15392 @end smallexample
15393
15394 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
15395
15396 @smallexample
15397 (@value{GDBP})
15398 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
15399 ^done,asm_insns=[
15400 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
15401 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15402 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15403 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15404 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
15405 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
15406 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15407 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15408 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15409 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15410 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15411 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
15412 (@value{GDBP})
15413 @end smallexample
15414
15415
15416 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
15417 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
15418
15419 @subsubheading Synopsis
15420
15421 @smallexample
15422 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
15423 @end smallexample
15424
15425 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
15426 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
15427 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
15428
15429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15430
15431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
15432 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
15433 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
15434
15435 @subsubheading Example
15436
15437 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
15438 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
15439 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
15440 output.
15441
15442 @smallexample
15443 211-data-evaluate-expression A
15444 211^done,value="1"
15445 (@value{GDBP})
15446 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
15447 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
15448 (@value{GDBP})
15449 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
15450 411^done,value="4"
15451 (@value{GDBP})
15452 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
15453 511^done,value="4"
15454 (@value{GDBP})
15455 @end smallexample
15456
15457
15458 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
15459 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
15460
15461 @subsubheading Synopsis
15462
15463 @smallexample
15464 -data-list-changed-registers
15465 @end smallexample
15466
15467 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
15468
15469 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15470
15471 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
15472 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
15473
15474 @subsubheading Example
15475
15476 On a PPC MBX board:
15477
15478 @smallexample
15479 (@value{GDBP})
15480 -exec-continue
15481 ^running
15482
15483 (@value{GDBP})
15484 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
15485 args=[],file="try.c",line="5"@}
15486 (@value{GDBP})
15487 -data-list-changed-registers
15488 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
15489 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
15490 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
15491 (@value{GDBP})
15492 @end smallexample
15493
15494
15495 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
15496 @findex -data-list-register-names
15497
15498 @subsubheading Synopsis
15499
15500 @smallexample
15501 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
15502 @end smallexample
15503
15504 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
15505 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
15506 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
15507 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
15508 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
15509 include empty register names.
15510
15511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15512
15513 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
15514 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
15515 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
15516
15517 @subsubheading Example
15518
15519 For the PPC MBX board:
15520 @smallexample
15521 (@value{GDBP})
15522 -data-list-register-names
15523 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
15524 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
15525 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
15526 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
15527 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
15528 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
15529 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
15530 (@value{GDBP})
15531 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
15532 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
15533 (@value{GDBP})
15534 @end smallexample
15535
15536 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
15537 @findex -data-list-register-values
15538
15539 @subsubheading Synopsis
15540
15541 @smallexample
15542 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
15543 @end smallexample
15544
15545 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
15546 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
15547 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
15548 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
15549
15550 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
15551
15552 @table @code
15553 @item x
15554 Hexadecimal
15555 @item o
15556 Octal
15557 @item t
15558 Binary
15559 @item d
15560 Decimal
15561 @item r
15562 Raw
15563 @item N
15564 Natural
15565 @end table
15566
15567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15568
15569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
15570 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
15571
15572 @subsubheading Example
15573
15574 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
15575 don't appear in the actual output):
15576
15577 @smallexample
15578 (@value{GDBP})
15579 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
15580 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15581 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
15582 (@value{GDBP})
15583 -data-list-register-values x
15584 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
15585 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15586 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
15587 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
15588 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
15589 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
15590 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
15591 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
15592 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
15593 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15594 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
15595 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
15596 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
15597 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
15598 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
15599 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
15600 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
15601 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
15602 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
15603 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
15604 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
15605 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
15606 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
15607 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
15608 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
15609 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
15610 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
15611 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
15612 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
15613 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
15614 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
15615 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
15616 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15617 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
15618 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
15619 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
15620 (@value{GDBP})
15621 @end smallexample
15622
15623
15624 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
15625 @findex -data-read-memory
15626
15627 @subsubheading Synopsis
15628
15629 @smallexample
15630 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
15631 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
15632 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
15633 @end smallexample
15634
15635 @noindent
15636 where:
15637
15638 @table @samp
15639 @item @var{address}
15640 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
15641 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
15642 quoted using the C convention.
15643
15644 @item @var{word-format}
15645 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
15646 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
15647 ,Output formats}).
15648
15649 @item @var{word-size}
15650 The size of each memory word in bytes.
15651
15652 @item @var{nr-rows}
15653 The number of rows in the output table.
15654
15655 @item @var{nr-cols}
15656 The number of columns in the output table.
15657
15658 @item @var{aschar}
15659 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
15660 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
15661 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
15662 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
15663
15664 @item @var{byte-offset}
15665 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
15666 @end table
15667
15668 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
15669 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
15670 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
15671 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
15672 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
15673 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
15674 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
15675 @samp{addr}.
15676
15677 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
15678 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
15679 @samp{prev-page}.
15680
15681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15682
15683 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
15684 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
15685
15686 @subsubheading Example
15687
15688 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
15689 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
15690 word. Display each word in hex.
15691
15692 @smallexample
15693 (@value{GDBP})
15694 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
15695 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
15696 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
15697 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
15698 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
15699 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
15700 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
15701 (@value{GDBP})
15702 @end smallexample
15703
15704 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
15705 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
15706
15707 @smallexample
15708 (@value{GDBP})
15709 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
15710 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
15711 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
15712 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
15713 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
15714 (@value{GDBP})
15715 @end smallexample
15716
15717 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
15718 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
15719 used as the non-printable character.
15720
15721 @smallexample
15722 (@value{GDBP})
15723 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
15724 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
15725 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
15726 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
15727 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15728 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15729 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15730 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15731 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
15732 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
15733 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
15734 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
15735 (@value{GDBP})
15736 @end smallexample
15737
15738 @subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
15739 @findex -display-delete
15740
15741 @subsubheading Synopsis
15742
15743 @smallexample
15744 -display-delete @var{number}
15745 @end smallexample
15746
15747 Delete the display @var{number}.
15748
15749 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15750
15751 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
15752
15753 @subsubheading Example
15754 N.A.
15755
15756
15757 @subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
15758 @findex -display-disable
15759
15760 @subsubheading Synopsis
15761
15762 @smallexample
15763 -display-disable @var{number}
15764 @end smallexample
15765
15766 Disable display @var{number}.
15767
15768 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15769
15770 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
15771
15772 @subsubheading Example
15773 N.A.
15774
15775
15776 @subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
15777 @findex -display-enable
15778
15779 @subsubheading Synopsis
15780
15781 @smallexample
15782 -display-enable @var{number}
15783 @end smallexample
15784
15785 Enable display @var{number}.
15786
15787 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15788
15789 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
15790
15791 @subsubheading Example
15792 N.A.
15793
15794
15795 @subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
15796 @findex -display-insert
15797
15798 @subsubheading Synopsis
15799
15800 @smallexample
15801 -display-insert @var{expression}
15802 @end smallexample
15803
15804 Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
15805
15806 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15807
15808 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
15809
15810 @subsubheading Example
15811 N.A.
15812
15813
15814 @subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
15815 @findex -display-list
15816
15817 @subsubheading Synopsis
15818
15819 @smallexample
15820 -display-list
15821 @end smallexample
15822
15823 List the displays. Do not show the current values.
15824
15825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15826
15827 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
15828
15829 @subsubheading Example
15830 N.A.
15831
15832
15833 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
15834 @findex -environment-cd
15835
15836 @subsubheading Synopsis
15837
15838 @smallexample
15839 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
15840 @end smallexample
15841
15842 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
15843
15844 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15845
15846 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
15847
15848 @subsubheading Example
15849
15850 @smallexample
15851 (@value{GDBP})
15852 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15853 ^done
15854 (@value{GDBP})
15855 @end smallexample
15856
15857
15858 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
15859 @findex -environment-directory
15860
15861 @subsubheading Synopsis
15862
15863 @smallexample
15864 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15865 @end smallexample
15866
15867 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
15868 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
15869 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
15870 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15871 occurs as normal.
15872 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15873 multiple directories in a single command
15874 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15875 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15876 If blanks are needed as
15877 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15878 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15879 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15880 character must not be used
15881 in any directory name.
15882 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
15883
15884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15885
15886 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
15887
15888 @subsubheading Example
15889
15890 @smallexample
15891 (@value{GDBP})
15892 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15893 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15894 (@value{GDBP})
15895 -environment-directory ""
15896 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15897 (@value{GDBP})
15898 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
15899 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
15900 (@value{GDBP})
15901 -environment-directory -r
15902 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
15903 (@value{GDBP})
15904 @end smallexample
15905
15906
15907 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
15908 @findex -environment-path
15909
15910 @subsubheading Synopsis
15911
15912 @smallexample
15913 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15914 @end smallexample
15915
15916 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
15917 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
15918 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
15919 supplied in addition to the
15920 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15921 occurs as normal.
15922 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15923 multiple directories in a single command
15924 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15925 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15926 If blanks are needed as
15927 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15928 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15929 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15930 character must not be used
15931 in any directory name.
15932 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
15933
15934
15935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15936
15937 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
15938
15939 @subsubheading Example
15940
15941 @smallexample
15942 (@value{GDBP})
15943 -environment-path
15944 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
15945 (@value{GDBP})
15946 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
15947 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
15948 (@value{GDBP})
15949 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
15950 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
15951 (@value{GDBP})
15952 @end smallexample
15953
15954
15955 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
15956 @findex -environment-pwd
15957
15958 @subsubheading Synopsis
15959
15960 @smallexample
15961 -environment-pwd
15962 @end smallexample
15963
15964 Show the current working directory.
15965
15966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15967
15968 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
15969
15970 @subsubheading Example
15971
15972 @smallexample
15973 (@value{GDBP})
15974 -environment-pwd
15975 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
15976 (@value{GDBP})
15977 @end smallexample
15978
15979 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15980 @node GDB/MI Program Control
15981 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
15982
15983 @subsubheading Program termination
15984
15985 As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
15986 it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
15987 include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
15988
15989 @subsubheading Examples
15990
15991 @noindent
15992 Program exited normally:
15993
15994 @smallexample
15995 (@value{GDBP})
15996 -exec-run
15997 ^running
15998 (@value{GDBP})
15999 x = 55
16000 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
16001 (@value{GDBP})
16002 @end smallexample
16003
16004 @noindent
16005 Program exited exceptionally:
16006
16007 @smallexample
16008 (@value{GDBP})
16009 -exec-run
16010 ^running
16011 (@value{GDBP})
16012 x = 55
16013 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
16014 (@value{GDBP})
16015 @end smallexample
16016
16017 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
16018 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
16019
16020 @smallexample
16021 (@value{GDBP})
16022 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
16023 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
16024 @end smallexample
16025
16026
16027 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
16028 @findex -exec-abort
16029
16030 @subsubheading Synopsis
16031
16032 @smallexample
16033 -exec-abort
16034 @end smallexample
16035
16036 Kill the inferior running program.
16037
16038 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16039
16040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
16041
16042 @subsubheading Example
16043 N.A.
16044
16045
16046 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
16047 @findex -exec-arguments
16048
16049 @subsubheading Synopsis
16050
16051 @smallexample
16052 -exec-arguments @var{args}
16053 @end smallexample
16054
16055 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
16056 @samp{-exec-run}.
16057
16058 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16059
16060 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
16061
16062 @subsubheading Example
16063
16064 @c FIXME!
16065 Don't have one around.
16066
16067
16068 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
16069 @findex -exec-continue
16070
16071 @subsubheading Synopsis
16072
16073 @smallexample
16074 -exec-continue
16075 @end smallexample
16076
16077 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16078 until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
16079
16080 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16081
16082 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
16083
16084 @subsubheading Example
16085
16086 @smallexample
16087 -exec-continue
16088 ^running
16089 (@value{GDBP})
16090 @@Hello world
16091 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
16092 file="hello.c",line="13"@}
16093 (@value{GDBP})
16094 @end smallexample
16095
16096
16097 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
16098 @findex -exec-finish
16099
16100 @subsubheading Synopsis
16101
16102 @smallexample
16103 -exec-finish
16104 @end smallexample
16105
16106 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16107 until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
16108 the function.
16109
16110 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16111
16112 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
16113
16114 @subsubheading Example
16115
16116 Function returning @code{void}.
16117
16118 @smallexample
16119 -exec-finish
16120 ^running
16121 (@value{GDBP})
16122 @@hello from foo
16123 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16124 file="hello.c",line="7"@}
16125 (@value{GDBP})
16126 @end smallexample
16127
16128 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
16129 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
16130 value itself.
16131
16132 @smallexample
16133 -exec-finish
16134 ^running
16135 (@value{GDBP})
16136 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
16137 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
16138 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16139 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
16140 (@value{GDBP})
16141 @end smallexample
16142
16143
16144 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
16145 @findex -exec-interrupt
16146
16147 @subsubheading Synopsis
16148
16149 @smallexample
16150 -exec-interrupt
16151 @end smallexample
16152
16153 Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
16154 Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
16155 execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
16156 itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
16157 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
16158
16159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16160
16161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
16162
16163 @subsubheading Example
16164
16165 @smallexample
16166 (@value{GDBP})
16167 111-exec-continue
16168 111^running
16169
16170 (@value{GDBP})
16171 222-exec-interrupt
16172 222^done
16173 (@value{GDBP})
16174 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
16175 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="13"@}
16176 (@value{GDBP})
16177
16178 (@value{GDBP})
16179 -exec-interrupt
16180 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
16181 (@value{GDBP})
16182 @end smallexample
16183
16184
16185 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
16186 @findex -exec-next
16187
16188 @subsubheading Synopsis
16189
16190 @smallexample
16191 -exec-next
16192 @end smallexample
16193
16194 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16195 when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
16196
16197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16198
16199 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
16200
16201 @subsubheading Example
16202
16203 @smallexample
16204 -exec-next
16205 ^running
16206 (@value{GDBP})
16207 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
16208 (@value{GDBP})
16209 @end smallexample
16210
16211
16212 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
16213 @findex -exec-next-instruction
16214
16215 @subsubheading Synopsis
16216
16217 @smallexample
16218 -exec-next-instruction
16219 @end smallexample
16220
16221 Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
16222 instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
16223 the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
16224 address will be printed as well.
16225
16226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16227
16228 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
16229
16230 @subsubheading Example
16231
16232 @smallexample
16233 (@value{GDBP})
16234 -exec-next-instruction
16235 ^running
16236
16237 (@value{GDBP})
16238 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16239 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
16240 (@value{GDBP})
16241 @end smallexample
16242
16243
16244 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
16245 @findex -exec-return
16246
16247 @subsubheading Synopsis
16248
16249 @smallexample
16250 -exec-return
16251 @end smallexample
16252
16253 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
16254 Displays the new current frame.
16255
16256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16257
16258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
16259
16260 @subsubheading Example
16261
16262 @smallexample
16263 (@value{GDBP})
16264 200-break-insert callee4
16265 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
16266 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16267 (@value{GDBP})
16268 000-exec-run
16269 000^running
16270 (@value{GDBP})
16271 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16272 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
16273 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16274 (@value{GDBP})
16275 205-break-delete
16276 205^done
16277 (@value{GDBP})
16278 111-exec-return
16279 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
16280 args=[@{name="strarg",
16281 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
16282 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
16283 (@value{GDBP})
16284 @end smallexample
16285
16286
16287 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
16288 @findex -exec-run
16289
16290 @subsubheading Synopsis
16291
16292 @smallexample
16293 -exec-run
16294 @end smallexample
16295
16296 Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
16297 beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
16298 encountered or the program exits.
16299
16300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16301
16302 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
16303
16304 @subsubheading Example
16305
16306 @smallexample
16307 (@value{GDBP})
16308 -break-insert main
16309 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16310 (@value{GDBP})
16311 -exec-run
16312 ^running
16313 (@value{GDBP})
16314 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16315 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16316 (@value{GDBP})
16317 @end smallexample
16318
16319
16320 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
16321 @findex -exec-show-arguments
16322
16323 @subsubheading Synopsis
16324
16325 @smallexample
16326 -exec-show-arguments
16327 @end smallexample
16328
16329 Print the arguments of the program.
16330
16331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16332
16333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
16334
16335 @subsubheading Example
16336 N.A.
16337
16338 @c @subheading -exec-signal
16339
16340 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
16341 @findex -exec-step
16342
16343 @subsubheading Synopsis
16344
16345 @smallexample
16346 -exec-step
16347 @end smallexample
16348
16349 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16350 when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
16351 source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
16352 instruction of the called function.
16353
16354 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16355
16356 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
16357
16358 @subsubheading Example
16359
16360 Stepping into a function:
16361
16362 @smallexample
16363 -exec-step
16364 ^running
16365 (@value{GDBP})
16366 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16367 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
16368 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
16369 (@value{GDBP})
16370 @end smallexample
16371
16372 Regular stepping:
16373
16374 @smallexample
16375 -exec-step
16376 ^running
16377 (@value{GDBP})
16378 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
16379 (@value{GDBP})
16380 @end smallexample
16381
16382
16383 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
16384 @findex -exec-step-instruction
16385
16386 @subsubheading Synopsis
16387
16388 @smallexample
16389 -exec-step-instruction
16390 @end smallexample
16391
16392 Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
16393 instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
16394 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
16395 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
16396 well.
16397
16398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16399
16400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
16401
16402 @subsubheading Example
16403
16404 @smallexample
16405 (@value{GDBP})
16406 -exec-step-instruction
16407 ^running
16408
16409 (@value{GDBP})
16410 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16411 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16412 (@value{GDBP})
16413 -exec-step-instruction
16414 ^running
16415
16416 (@value{GDBP})
16417 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16418 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16419 (@value{GDBP})
16420 @end smallexample
16421
16422
16423 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
16424 @findex -exec-until
16425
16426 @subsubheading Synopsis
16427
16428 @smallexample
16429 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
16430 @end smallexample
16431
16432 Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
16433 specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
16434 executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
16435 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
16436
16437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16438
16439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
16440
16441 @subsubheading Example
16442
16443 @smallexample
16444 (@value{GDBP})
16445 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
16446 ^running
16447 (@value{GDBP})
16448 x = 55
16449 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16450 file="recursive2.c",line="6"@}
16451 (@value{GDBP})
16452 @end smallexample
16453
16454 @ignore
16455 @subheading -file-clear
16456 Is this going away????
16457 @end ignore
16458
16459
16460 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
16461 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
16462
16463 @subsubheading Synopsis
16464
16465 @smallexample
16466 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
16467 @end smallexample
16468
16469 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
16470 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
16471 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
16472 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
16473 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
16474 notification.
16475
16476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16477
16478 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
16479
16480 @subsubheading Example
16481
16482 @smallexample
16483 (@value{GDBP})
16484 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16485 ^done
16486 (@value{GDBP})
16487 @end smallexample
16488
16489
16490 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
16491 @findex -file-exec-file
16492
16493 @subsubheading Synopsis
16494
16495 @smallexample
16496 -file-exec-file @var{file}
16497 @end smallexample
16498
16499 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
16500 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
16501 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
16502 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
16503 notification.
16504
16505 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16506
16507 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
16508
16509 @subsubheading Example
16510
16511 @smallexample
16512 (@value{GDBP})
16513 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16514 ^done
16515 (@value{GDBP})
16516 @end smallexample
16517
16518
16519 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
16520 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
16521
16522 @subsubheading Synopsis
16523
16524 @smallexample
16525 -file-list-exec-sections
16526 @end smallexample
16527
16528 List the sections of the current executable file.
16529
16530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16531
16532 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
16533 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
16534 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
16535
16536 @subsubheading Example
16537 N.A.
16538
16539
16540 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
16541 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
16542
16543 @subsubheading Synopsis
16544
16545 @smallexample
16546 -file-list-exec-source-file
16547 @end smallexample
16548
16549 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
16550 to the current source file for the current executable.
16551
16552 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16553
16554 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16555
16556 @subsubheading Example
16557
16558 @smallexample
16559 (@value{GDBP})
16560 123-file-list-exec-source-file
16561 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
16562 (@value{GDBP})
16563 @end smallexample
16564
16565
16566 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
16567 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
16568
16569 @subsubheading Synopsis
16570
16571 @smallexample
16572 -file-list-exec-source-files
16573 @end smallexample
16574
16575 List the source files for the current executable.
16576
16577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16578
16579 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16580 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
16581
16582 @subsubheading Example
16583 N.A.
16584
16585
16586 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
16587 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
16588
16589 @subsubheading Synopsis
16590
16591 @smallexample
16592 -file-list-shared-libraries
16593 @end smallexample
16594
16595 List the shared libraries in the program.
16596
16597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16598
16599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
16600
16601 @subsubheading Example
16602 N.A.
16603
16604
16605 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
16606 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
16607
16608 @subsubheading Synopsis
16609
16610 @smallexample
16611 -file-list-symbol-files
16612 @end smallexample
16613
16614 List symbol files.
16615
16616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16617
16618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
16619
16620 @subsubheading Example
16621 N.A.
16622
16623
16624 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
16625 @findex -file-symbol-file
16626
16627 @subsubheading Synopsis
16628
16629 @smallexample
16630 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
16631 @end smallexample
16632
16633 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
16634 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
16635 produced, except for a completion notification.
16636
16637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16638
16639 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
16640
16641 @subsubheading Example
16642
16643 @smallexample
16644 (@value{GDBP})
16645 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16646 ^done
16647 (@value{GDBP})
16648 @end smallexample
16649
16650 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16651 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
16652 @section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
16653
16654 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
16655
16656 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
16657 @findex -gdb-exit
16658
16659 @subsubheading Synopsis
16660
16661 @smallexample
16662 -gdb-exit
16663 @end smallexample
16664
16665 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
16666
16667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16668
16669 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
16670
16671 @subsubheading Example
16672
16673 @smallexample
16674 (@value{GDBP})
16675 -gdb-exit
16676 @end smallexample
16677
16678 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
16679 @findex -gdb-set
16680
16681 @subsubheading Synopsis
16682
16683 @smallexample
16684 -gdb-set
16685 @end smallexample
16686
16687 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
16688 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
16689
16690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16691
16692 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
16693
16694 @subsubheading Example
16695
16696 @smallexample
16697 (@value{GDBP})
16698 -gdb-set $foo=3
16699 ^done
16700 (@value{GDBP})
16701 @end smallexample
16702
16703
16704 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
16705 @findex -gdb-show
16706
16707 @subsubheading Synopsis
16708
16709 @smallexample
16710 -gdb-show
16711 @end smallexample
16712
16713 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
16714
16715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16716
16717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
16718
16719 @subsubheading Example
16720
16721 @smallexample
16722 (@value{GDBP})
16723 -gdb-show annotate
16724 ^done,value="0"
16725 (@value{GDBP})
16726 @end smallexample
16727
16728 @c @subheading -gdb-source
16729
16730
16731 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
16732 @findex -gdb-version
16733
16734 @subsubheading Synopsis
16735
16736 @smallexample
16737 -gdb-version
16738 @end smallexample
16739
16740 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
16741
16742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16743
16744 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
16745 information when you start an interactive session.
16746
16747 @subsubheading Example
16748
16749 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
16750 @c box in TeX.
16751 @smallexample
16752 (@value{GDBP})
16753 -gdb-version
16754 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
16755 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
16756 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
16757 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
16758 ~ certain conditions.
16759 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
16760 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
16761 ~ details.
16762 ~This GDB was configured as
16763 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
16764 ^done
16765 (@value{GDBP})
16766 @end smallexample
16767
16768 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
16769 @findex -interpreter-exec
16770
16771 @subheading Synopsis
16772
16773 @smallexample
16774 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
16775 @end smallexample
16776
16777 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
16778
16779 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
16780
16781 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
16782
16783 @subheading Example
16784
16785 @smallexample
16786 (@value{GDBP})
16787 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
16788 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
16789 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
16790 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
16791 ^done
16792 (@value{GDBP})
16793 @end smallexample
16794
16795 @ignore
16796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16797 @node GDB/MI Kod Commands
16798 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
16799
16800 The Kod commands are not implemented.
16801
16802 @c @subheading -kod-info
16803
16804 @c @subheading -kod-list
16805
16806 @c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
16807
16808 @c @subheading -kod-show
16809
16810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16811 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
16812 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
16813
16814 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
16815
16816 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
16817
16818 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
16819
16820 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
16821
16822 @c @subheading -overlay-map
16823
16824 @c @subheading -overlay-off
16825
16826 @c @subheading -overlay-on
16827
16828 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
16829
16830 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16831 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
16832 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
16833
16834 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
16835
16836 @c @subheading -signal-handle
16837
16838 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
16839
16840 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
16841 @end ignore
16842
16843
16844 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16845 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
16846 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
16847
16848
16849 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
16850 @findex -stack-info-frame
16851
16852 @subsubheading Synopsis
16853
16854 @smallexample
16855 -stack-info-frame
16856 @end smallexample
16857
16858 Get info on the current frame.
16859
16860 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16861
16862 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
16863 (without arguments).
16864
16865 @subsubheading Example
16866 N.A.
16867
16868 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
16869 @findex -stack-info-depth
16870
16871 @subsubheading Synopsis
16872
16873 @smallexample
16874 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
16875 @end smallexample
16876
16877 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
16878 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
16879
16880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16881
16882 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
16883
16884 @subsubheading Example
16885
16886 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
16887
16888 @smallexample
16889 (@value{GDBP})
16890 -stack-info-depth
16891 ^done,depth="12"
16892 (@value{GDBP})
16893 -stack-info-depth 4
16894 ^done,depth="4"
16895 (@value{GDBP})
16896 -stack-info-depth 12
16897 ^done,depth="12"
16898 (@value{GDBP})
16899 -stack-info-depth 11
16900 ^done,depth="11"
16901 (@value{GDBP})
16902 -stack-info-depth 13
16903 ^done,depth="12"
16904 (@value{GDBP})
16905 @end smallexample
16906
16907 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
16908 @findex -stack-list-arguments
16909
16910 @subsubheading Synopsis
16911
16912 @smallexample
16913 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
16914 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16915 @end smallexample
16916
16917 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
16918 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
16919 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
16920 stack.
16921
16922 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
16923 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
16924 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
16925
16926 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16927
16928 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
16929 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
16930 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
16931
16932 @subsubheading Example
16933
16934 @smallexample
16935 (@value{GDBP})
16936 -stack-list-frames
16937 ^done,
16938 stack=[
16939 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
16940 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
16941 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
16942 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
16943 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
16944 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
16945 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
16946 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
16947 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
16948 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
16949 (@value{GDBP})
16950 -stack-list-arguments 0
16951 ^done,
16952 stack-args=[
16953 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16954 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
16955 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
16956 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
16957 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16958 (@value{GDBP})
16959 -stack-list-arguments 1
16960 ^done,
16961 stack-args=[
16962 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16963 frame=@{level="1",
16964 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16965 frame=@{level="2",args=[
16966 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16967 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16968 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
16969 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16970 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
16971 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
16972 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16973 (@value{GDBP})
16974 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
16975 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
16976 (@value{GDBP})
16977 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
16978 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
16979 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16980 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
16981 (@value{GDBP})
16982 @end smallexample
16983
16984 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
16985
16986
16987 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
16988 @findex -stack-list-frames
16989
16990 @subsubheading Synopsis
16991
16992 @smallexample
16993 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16994 @end smallexample
16995
16996 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
16997 following info:
16998
16999 @table @samp
17000 @item @var{level}
17001 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
17002 @item @var{addr}
17003 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
17004 @item @var{func}
17005 Function name.
17006 @item @var{file}
17007 File name of the source file where the function lives.
17008 @item @var{line}
17009 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
17010 @end table
17011
17012 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
17013 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
17014 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
17015 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
17016
17017 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17018
17019 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
17020
17021 @subsubheading Example
17022
17023 Full stack backtrace:
17024
17025 @smallexample
17026 (@value{GDBP})
17027 -stack-list-frames
17028 ^done,stack=
17029 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
17030 file="recursive2.c",line="11"@},
17031 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17032 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17033 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17034 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17035 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17036 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17037 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17038 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17039 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17040 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17041 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17042 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17043 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17044 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17045 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17046 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17047 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17048 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17049 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17050 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17051 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
17052 file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
17053 (@value{GDBP})
17054 @end smallexample
17055
17056 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
17057
17058 @smallexample
17059 (@value{GDBP})
17060 -stack-list-frames 3 5
17061 ^done,stack=
17062 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17063 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17064 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17065 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17066 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17067 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17068 (@value{GDBP})
17069 @end smallexample
17070
17071 Show a single frame:
17072
17073 @smallexample
17074 (@value{GDBP})
17075 -stack-list-frames 3 3
17076 ^done,stack=
17077 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17078 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17079 (@value{GDBP})
17080 @end smallexample
17081
17082
17083 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
17084 @findex -stack-list-locals
17085
17086 @subsubheading Synopsis
17087
17088 @smallexample
17089 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
17090 @end smallexample
17091
17092 Display the local variable names for the current frame. With an
17093 argument of 0 prints only the names of the variables, with argument of 1
17094 prints also their values.
17095
17096 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17097
17098 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
17099
17100 @subsubheading Example
17101
17102 @smallexample
17103 (@value{GDBP})
17104 -stack-list-locals 0
17105 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
17106 (@value{GDBP})
17107 -stack-list-locals 1
17108 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
17109 @{name="C",value="3"@}]
17110 (@value{GDBP})
17111 @end smallexample
17112
17113
17114 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
17115 @findex -stack-select-frame
17116
17117 @subsubheading Synopsis
17118
17119 @smallexample
17120 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
17121 @end smallexample
17122
17123 Change the current frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
17124 the stack.
17125
17126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17127
17128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
17129 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
17130
17131 @subsubheading Example
17132
17133 @smallexample
17134 (@value{GDBP})
17135 -stack-select-frame 2
17136 ^done
17137 (@value{GDBP})
17138 @end smallexample
17139
17140 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17141 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
17142 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
17143
17144
17145 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
17146 @findex -symbol-info-address
17147
17148 @subsubheading Synopsis
17149
17150 @smallexample
17151 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
17152 @end smallexample
17153
17154 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
17155
17156 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17157
17158 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
17159
17160 @subsubheading Example
17161 N.A.
17162
17163
17164 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
17165 @findex -symbol-info-file
17166
17167 @subsubheading Synopsis
17168
17169 @smallexample
17170 -symbol-info-file
17171 @end smallexample
17172
17173 Show the file for the symbol.
17174
17175 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17176
17177 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
17178 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
17179
17180 @subsubheading Example
17181 N.A.
17182
17183
17184 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
17185 @findex -symbol-info-function
17186
17187 @subsubheading Synopsis
17188
17189 @smallexample
17190 -symbol-info-function
17191 @end smallexample
17192
17193 Show which function the symbol lives in.
17194
17195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17196
17197 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
17198
17199 @subsubheading Example
17200 N.A.
17201
17202
17203 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
17204 @findex -symbol-info-line
17205
17206 @subsubheading Synopsis
17207
17208 @smallexample
17209 -symbol-info-line
17210 @end smallexample
17211
17212 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
17213
17214 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17215
17216 The corresponding @value{GDBN} comamnd is @samp{info line}.
17217 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
17218
17219 @subsubheading Example
17220 N.A.
17221
17222
17223 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
17224 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
17225
17226 @subsubheading Synopsis
17227
17228 @smallexample
17229 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
17230 @end smallexample
17231
17232 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
17233
17234 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17235
17236 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
17237
17238 @subsubheading Example
17239 N.A.
17240
17241
17242 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
17243 @findex -symbol-list-functions
17244
17245 @subsubheading Synopsis
17246
17247 @smallexample
17248 -symbol-list-functions
17249 @end smallexample
17250
17251 List the functions in the executable.
17252
17253 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17254
17255 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
17256 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17257
17258 @subsubheading Example
17259 N.A.
17260
17261
17262 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
17263 @findex -symbol-list-lines
17264
17265 @subsubheading Synopsis
17266
17267 @smallexample
17268 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
17269 @end smallexample
17270
17271 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
17272 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
17273 ascending PC order.
17274
17275 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17276
17277 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
17278
17279 @subsubheading Example
17280 @smallexample
17281 (@value{GDBP})
17282 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
17283 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
17284 (@value{GDBP})
17285 @end smallexample
17286
17287
17288 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
17289 @findex -symbol-list-types
17290
17291 @subsubheading Synopsis
17292
17293 @smallexample
17294 -symbol-list-types
17295 @end smallexample
17296
17297 List all the type names.
17298
17299 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17300
17301 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
17302 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17303
17304 @subsubheading Example
17305 N.A.
17306
17307
17308 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
17309 @findex -symbol-list-variables
17310
17311 @subsubheading Synopsis
17312
17313 @smallexample
17314 -symbol-list-variables
17315 @end smallexample
17316
17317 List all the global and static variable names.
17318
17319 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17320
17321 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17322
17323 @subsubheading Example
17324 N.A.
17325
17326
17327 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
17328 @findex -symbol-locate
17329
17330 @subsubheading Synopsis
17331
17332 @smallexample
17333 -symbol-locate
17334 @end smallexample
17335
17336 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17337
17338 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
17339
17340 @subsubheading Example
17341 N.A.
17342
17343
17344 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
17345 @findex -symbol-type
17346
17347 @subsubheading Synopsis
17348
17349 @smallexample
17350 -symbol-type @var{variable}
17351 @end smallexample
17352
17353 Show type of @var{variable}.
17354
17355 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17356
17357 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
17358 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
17359
17360 @subsubheading Example
17361 N.A.
17362
17363
17364 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17365 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
17366 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
17367
17368
17369 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
17370 @findex -target-attach
17371
17372 @subsubheading Synopsis
17373
17374 @smallexample
17375 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
17376 @end smallexample
17377
17378 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
17379
17380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17381
17382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
17383
17384 @subsubheading Example
17385 N.A.
17386
17387
17388 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
17389 @findex -target-compare-sections
17390
17391 @subsubheading Synopsis
17392
17393 @smallexample
17394 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
17395 @end smallexample
17396
17397 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
17398 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
17399
17400 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17401
17402 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
17403
17404 @subsubheading Example
17405 N.A.
17406
17407
17408 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
17409 @findex -target-detach
17410
17411 @subsubheading Synopsis
17412
17413 @smallexample
17414 -target-detach
17415 @end smallexample
17416
17417 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17418
17419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17420
17421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
17422
17423 @subsubheading Example
17424
17425 @smallexample
17426 (@value{GDBP})
17427 -target-detach
17428 ^done
17429 (@value{GDBP})
17430 @end smallexample
17431
17432
17433 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
17434 @findex -target-disconnect
17435
17436 @subsubheading Synopsis
17437
17438 @example
17439 -target-disconnect
17440 @end example
17441
17442 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17443
17444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17445
17446 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
17447
17448 @subsubheading Example
17449
17450 @smallexample
17451 (@value{GDBP})
17452 -target-disconnect
17453 ^done
17454 (@value{GDBP})
17455 @end smallexample
17456
17457
17458 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
17459 @findex -target-download
17460
17461 @subsubheading Synopsis
17462
17463 @smallexample
17464 -target-download
17465 @end smallexample
17466
17467 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
17468 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
17469
17470 @table @samp
17471 @item section
17472 The name of the section.
17473 @item section-sent
17474 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
17475 @item section-size
17476 The size of the section.
17477 @item total-sent
17478 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
17479 @item total-size
17480 The size of the overall executable to download.
17481 @end table
17482
17483 @noindent
17484 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
17485 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
17486
17487 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
17488 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
17489
17490 @table @samp
17491 @item section
17492 The name of the section.
17493 @item section-size
17494 The size of the section.
17495 @item total-size
17496 The size of the overall executable to download.
17497 @end table
17498
17499 @noindent
17500 At the end, a summary is printed.
17501
17502 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17503
17504 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
17505
17506 @subsubheading Example
17507
17508 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
17509 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
17510
17511 @smallexample
17512 (@value{GDBP})
17513 -target-download
17514 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
17515 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
17516 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
17517 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
17518 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
17519 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
17520 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
17521 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
17522 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
17523 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
17524 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
17525 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
17526 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
17527 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
17528 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
17529 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
17530 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
17531 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
17532 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
17533 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
17534 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
17535 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
17536 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
17537 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
17538 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
17539 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
17540 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
17541 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17542 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17543 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
17544 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
17545 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
17546 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
17547 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
17548 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
17549 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
17550 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
17551 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
17552 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
17553 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
17554 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
17555 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
17556 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
17557 write-rate="429"
17558 (@value{GDBP})
17559 @end smallexample
17560
17561
17562 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
17563 @findex -target-exec-status
17564
17565 @subsubheading Synopsis
17566
17567 @smallexample
17568 -target-exec-status
17569 @end smallexample
17570
17571 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
17572 not, for instance).
17573
17574 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17575
17576 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17577
17578 @subsubheading Example
17579 N.A.
17580
17581
17582 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
17583 @findex -target-list-available-targets
17584
17585 @subsubheading Synopsis
17586
17587 @smallexample
17588 -target-list-available-targets
17589 @end smallexample
17590
17591 List the possible targets to connect to.
17592
17593 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17594
17595 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
17596
17597 @subsubheading Example
17598 N.A.
17599
17600
17601 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
17602 @findex -target-list-current-targets
17603
17604 @subsubheading Synopsis
17605
17606 @smallexample
17607 -target-list-current-targets
17608 @end smallexample
17609
17610 Describe the current target.
17611
17612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17613
17614 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
17615 other things).
17616
17617 @subsubheading Example
17618 N.A.
17619
17620
17621 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
17622 @findex -target-list-parameters
17623
17624 @subsubheading Synopsis
17625
17626 @smallexample
17627 -target-list-parameters
17628 @end smallexample
17629
17630 @c ????
17631
17632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17633
17634 No equivalent.
17635
17636 @subsubheading Example
17637 N.A.
17638
17639
17640 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
17641 @findex -target-select
17642
17643 @subsubheading Synopsis
17644
17645 @smallexample
17646 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
17647 @end smallexample
17648
17649 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
17650
17651 @table @samp
17652 @item @var{type}
17653 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
17654 @item @var{parameters}
17655 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
17656 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
17657 @end table
17658
17659 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
17660 which the target program is, in the following form:
17661
17662 @smallexample
17663 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
17664 args=[@var{arg list}]
17665 @end smallexample
17666
17667 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17668
17669 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
17670
17671 @subsubheading Example
17672
17673 @smallexample
17674 (@value{GDBP})
17675 -target-select async /dev/ttya
17676 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
17677 (@value{GDBP})
17678 @end smallexample
17679
17680 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17681 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
17682 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
17683
17684
17685 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
17686 @findex -thread-info
17687
17688 @subsubheading Synopsis
17689
17690 @smallexample
17691 -thread-info
17692 @end smallexample
17693
17694 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17695
17696 No equivalent.
17697
17698 @subsubheading Example
17699 N.A.
17700
17701
17702 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
17703 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
17704
17705 @subsubheading Synopsis
17706
17707 @smallexample
17708 -thread-list-all-threads
17709 @end smallexample
17710
17711 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17712
17713 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
17714
17715 @subsubheading Example
17716 N.A.
17717
17718
17719 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
17720 @findex -thread-list-ids
17721
17722 @subsubheading Synopsis
17723
17724 @smallexample
17725 -thread-list-ids
17726 @end smallexample
17727
17728 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
17729 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
17730
17731 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17732
17733 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
17734
17735 @subsubheading Example
17736
17737 No threads present, besides the main process:
17738
17739 @smallexample
17740 (@value{GDBP})
17741 -thread-list-ids
17742 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
17743 (@value{GDBP})
17744 @end smallexample
17745
17746
17747 Several threads:
17748
17749 @smallexample
17750 (@value{GDBP})
17751 -thread-list-ids
17752 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17753 number-of-threads="3"
17754 (@value{GDBP})
17755 @end smallexample
17756
17757
17758 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
17759 @findex -thread-select
17760
17761 @subsubheading Synopsis
17762
17763 @smallexample
17764 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
17765 @end smallexample
17766
17767 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
17768 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
17769
17770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17771
17772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
17773
17774 @subsubheading Example
17775
17776 @smallexample
17777 (@value{GDBP})
17778 -exec-next
17779 ^running
17780 (@value{GDBP})
17781 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
17782 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
17783 (@value{GDBP})
17784 -thread-list-ids
17785 ^done,
17786 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17787 number-of-threads="3"
17788 (@value{GDBP})
17789 -thread-select 3
17790 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
17791 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
17792 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
17793 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
17794 (@value{GDBP})
17795 @end smallexample
17796
17797 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17798 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
17799 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
17800
17801 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
17802
17803 @c @subheading -trace-actions
17804
17805 @c @subheading -trace-delete
17806
17807 @c @subheading -trace-disable
17808
17809 @c @subheading -trace-dump
17810
17811 @c @subheading -trace-enable
17812
17813 @c @subheading -trace-exists
17814
17815 @c @subheading -trace-find
17816
17817 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
17818
17819 @c @subheading -trace-info
17820
17821 @c @subheading -trace-insert
17822
17823 @c @subheading -trace-list
17824
17825 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
17826
17827 @c @subheading -trace-save
17828
17829 @c @subheading -trace-start
17830
17831 @c @subheading -trace-stop
17832
17833
17834 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17835 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
17836 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
17837
17838
17839 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17840
17841 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
17842 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
17843 used by @code{Insight}.
17844
17845 The two main reasons for that are:
17846
17847 @enumerate 1
17848 @item
17849 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
17850
17851 @item
17852 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
17853 now).
17854 @end enumerate
17855
17856 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
17857 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
17858 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
17859 hints about their use.
17860
17861 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
17862 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
17863 least, the following operations:
17864
17865 @itemize @bullet
17866 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
17867 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
17868 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
17869 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
17870 @end itemize
17871
17872 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17873
17874 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17875 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
17876 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
17877 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
17878 examining or changing its properties.
17879
17880 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
17881 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
17882 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
17883 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
17884 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
17885
17886 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
17887 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
17888 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
17889 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
17890 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
17891 for pointers, etc.).
17892
17893 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
17894 access this functionality:
17895
17896 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
17897 @item @strong{Operation}
17898 @tab @strong{Description}
17899
17900 @item @code{-var-create}
17901 @tab create a variable object
17902 @item @code{-var-delete}
17903 @tab delete the variable object and its children
17904 @item @code{-var-set-format}
17905 @tab set the display format of this variable
17906 @item @code{-var-show-format}
17907 @tab show the display format of this variable
17908 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
17909 @tab tells how many children this object has
17910 @item @code{-var-list-children}
17911 @tab return a list of the object's children
17912 @item @code{-var-info-type}
17913 @tab show the type of this variable object
17914 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
17915 @tab print what this variable object represents
17916 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
17917 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
17918 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
17919 @tab get the value of this variable
17920 @item @code{-var-assign}
17921 @tab set the value of this variable
17922 @item @code{-var-update}
17923 @tab update the variable and its children
17924 @end multitable
17925
17926 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
17927 how it can be used.
17928
17929 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
17930
17931 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
17932 @findex -var-create
17933
17934 @subsubheading Synopsis
17935
17936 @smallexample
17937 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
17938 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
17939 @end smallexample
17940
17941 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
17942 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
17943 register.
17944
17945 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
17946 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
17947 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
17948 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
17949 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
17950
17951 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
17952 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
17953 frame should be used.
17954
17955 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
17956 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
17957
17958 @itemize @bullet
17959 @item
17960 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
17961
17962 @item
17963 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
17964
17965 @item
17966 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
17967 @end itemize
17968
17969 @subsubheading Result
17970
17971 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
17972 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
17973 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
17974
17975 @smallexample
17976 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
17977 @end smallexample
17978
17979
17980 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
17981 @findex -var-delete
17982
17983 @subsubheading Synopsis
17984
17985 @smallexample
17986 -var-delete @var{name}
17987 @end smallexample
17988
17989 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
17990
17991 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
17992
17993
17994 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
17995 @findex -var-set-format
17996
17997 @subsubheading Synopsis
17998
17999 @smallexample
18000 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
18001 @end smallexample
18002
18003 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
18004 @var{format-spec}.
18005
18006 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
18007
18008 @smallexample
18009 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
18010 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
18011 @end smallexample
18012
18013
18014 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
18015 @findex -var-show-format
18016
18017 @subsubheading Synopsis
18018
18019 @smallexample
18020 -var-show-format @var{name}
18021 @end smallexample
18022
18023 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
18024
18025 @smallexample
18026 @var{format} @expansion{}
18027 @var{format-spec}
18028 @end smallexample
18029
18030
18031 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
18032 @findex -var-info-num-children
18033
18034 @subsubheading Synopsis
18035
18036 @smallexample
18037 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
18038 @end smallexample
18039
18040 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
18041
18042 @smallexample
18043 numchild=@var{n}
18044 @end smallexample
18045
18046
18047 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
18048 @findex -var-list-children
18049
18050 @subsubheading Synopsis
18051
18052 @smallexample
18053 -var-list-children @var{name}
18054 @end smallexample
18055
18056 Returns a list of the children of the specified variable object:
18057
18058 @smallexample
18059 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
18060 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
18061 @end smallexample
18062
18063
18064 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
18065 @findex -var-info-type
18066
18067 @subsubheading Synopsis
18068
18069 @smallexample
18070 -var-info-type @var{name}
18071 @end smallexample
18072
18073 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
18074 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
18075 @value{GDBN} CLI:
18076
18077 @smallexample
18078 type=@var{typename}
18079 @end smallexample
18080
18081
18082 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
18083 @findex -var-info-expression
18084
18085 @subsubheading Synopsis
18086
18087 @smallexample
18088 -var-info-expression @var{name}
18089 @end smallexample
18090
18091 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
18092
18093 @smallexample
18094 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
18095 @end smallexample
18096
18097 @noindent
18098 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
18099
18100 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
18101 @findex -var-show-attributes
18102
18103 @subsubheading Synopsis
18104
18105 @smallexample
18106 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
18107 @end smallexample
18108
18109 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
18110
18111 @smallexample
18112 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
18113 @end smallexample
18114
18115 @noindent
18116 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
18117
18118 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
18119 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
18120
18121 @subsubheading Synopsis
18122
18123 @smallexample
18124 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
18125 @end smallexample
18126
18127 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
18128 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
18129 for the object:
18130
18131 @smallexample
18132 value=@var{value}
18133 @end smallexample
18134
18135 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
18136 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
18137
18138 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
18139 @findex -var-assign
18140
18141 @subsubheading Synopsis
18142
18143 @smallexample
18144 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
18145 @end smallexample
18146
18147 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
18148 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
18149 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
18150 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
18151
18152 @subsubheading Example
18153
18154 @smallexample
18155 (@value{GDBP})
18156 -var-assign var1 3
18157 ^done,value="3"
18158 (@value{GDBP})
18159 -var-update *
18160 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
18161 (@value{GDBP})
18162 @end smallexample
18163
18164 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
18165 @findex -var-update
18166
18167 @subsubheading Synopsis
18168
18169 @smallexample
18170 -var-update @{@var{name} | "*"@}
18171 @end smallexample
18172
18173 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
18174 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
18175 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated.
18176
18177
18178 @node Annotations
18179 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
18180
18181 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations are
18182 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or
18183 other similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
18184 relatively high level.
18185
18186 @ignore
18187 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
18188 @end ignore
18189
18190 @menu
18191 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
18192 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
18193 * Value Annotations:: Values are marked as such.
18194 * Frame Annotations:: Stack frames are annotated.
18195 * Displays:: @value{GDBN} can be told to display something periodically.
18196 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
18197 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
18198 * Breakpoint Info:: Information on breakpoints.
18199 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
18200 * Annotations for Running::
18201 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
18202 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
18203 * TODO:: Annotations which might be added in the future.
18204 @end menu
18205
18206 @node Annotations Overview
18207 @section What is an Annotation?
18208 @cindex annotations
18209
18210 To produce annotations, start @value{GDBN} with the @code{--annotate=2} option.
18211
18212 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
18213 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
18214 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
18215 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
18216 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
18217 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
18218 cannot contain newline characters.
18219
18220 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
18221 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
18222 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
18223 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
18224 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
18225 means those three characters as output.
18226
18227 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
18228
18229 @smallexample
18230 $ gdb --annotate=2
18231 GNU GDB 5.0
18232 Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
18233 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
18234 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
18235 under certain conditions.
18236 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
18237 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
18238 for details.
18239 This GDB was configured as "sparc-sun-sunos4.1.3"
18240
18241 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18242 (gdb)
18243 ^Z^Zprompt
18244 quit
18245
18246 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18247 $
18248 @end smallexample
18249
18250 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
18251 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
18252 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
18253 output from @value{GDBN}.
18254
18255 @node Server Prefix
18256 @section The Server Prefix
18257 @cindex server prefix for annotations
18258
18259 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18260 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
18261 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18262 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18263 pressed on a line by itself.
18264
18265 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18266 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18267 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18268
18269 @node Value Annotations
18270 @section Values
18271
18272 @cindex annotations for values
18273 When a value is printed in various contexts, @value{GDBN} uses
18274 annotations to delimit the value from the surrounding text.
18275
18276 @findex value-history-begin
18277 @findex value-history-value
18278 @findex value-history-end
18279 If a value is printed using @code{print} and added to the value history,
18280 the annotation looks like
18281
18282 @smallexample
18283 ^Z^Zvalue-history-begin @var{history-number} @var{value-flags}
18284 @var{history-string}
18285 ^Z^Zvalue-history-value
18286 @var{the-value}
18287 ^Z^Zvalue-history-end
18288 @end smallexample
18289
18290 @noindent
18291 where @var{history-number} is the number it is getting in the value
18292 history, @var{history-string} is a string, such as @samp{$5 = }, which
18293 introduces the value to the user, @var{the-value} is the output
18294 corresponding to the value itself, and @var{value-flags} is @samp{*} for
18295 a value which can be dereferenced and @samp{-} for a value which cannot.
18296
18297 @findex value-begin
18298 @findex value-end
18299 If the value is not added to the value history (it is an invalid float
18300 or it is printed with the @code{output} command), the annotation is similar:
18301
18302 @smallexample
18303 ^Z^Zvalue-begin @var{value-flags}
18304 @var{the-value}
18305 ^Z^Zvalue-end
18306 @end smallexample
18307
18308 @findex arg-begin
18309 @findex arg-name-end
18310 @findex arg-value
18311 @findex arg-end
18312 When @value{GDBN} prints an argument to a function (for example, in the output
18313 from the @code{backtrace} command), it annotates it as follows:
18314
18315 @smallexample
18316 ^Z^Zarg-begin
18317 @var{argument-name}
18318 ^Z^Zarg-name-end
18319 @var{separator-string}
18320 ^Z^Zarg-value @var{value-flags}
18321 @var{the-value}
18322 ^Z^Zarg-end
18323 @end smallexample
18324
18325 @noindent
18326 where @var{argument-name} is the name of the argument,
18327 @var{separator-string} is text which separates the name from the value
18328 for the user's benefit (such as @samp{=}), and @var{value-flags} and
18329 @var{the-value} have the same meanings as in a
18330 @code{value-history-begin} annotation.
18331
18332 @findex field-begin
18333 @findex field-name-end
18334 @findex field-value
18335 @findex field-end
18336 When printing a structure, @value{GDBN} annotates it as follows:
18337
18338 @smallexample
18339 ^Z^Zfield-begin @var{value-flags}
18340 @var{field-name}
18341 ^Z^Zfield-name-end
18342 @var{separator-string}
18343 ^Z^Zfield-value
18344 @var{the-value}
18345 ^Z^Zfield-end
18346 @end smallexample
18347
18348 @noindent
18349 where @var{field-name} is the name of the field, @var{separator-string}
18350 is text which separates the name from the value for the user's benefit
18351 (such as @samp{=}), and @var{value-flags} and @var{the-value} have the
18352 same meanings as in a @code{value-history-begin} annotation.
18353
18354 When printing an array, @value{GDBN} annotates it as follows:
18355
18356 @smallexample
18357 ^Z^Zarray-section-begin @var{array-index} @var{value-flags}
18358 @end smallexample
18359
18360 @noindent
18361 where @var{array-index} is the index of the first element being
18362 annotated and @var{value-flags} has the same meaning as in a
18363 @code{value-history-begin} annotation. This is followed by any number
18364 of elements, where is element can be either a single element:
18365
18366 @findex elt
18367 @smallexample
18368 @samp{,} @var{whitespace} ; @r{omitted for the first element}
18369 @var{the-value}
18370 ^Z^Zelt
18371 @end smallexample
18372
18373 or a repeated element
18374
18375 @findex elt-rep
18376 @findex elt-rep-end
18377 @smallexample
18378 @samp{,} @var{whitespace} ; @r{omitted for the first element}
18379 @var{the-value}
18380 ^Z^Zelt-rep @var{number-of-repetitions}
18381 @var{repetition-string}
18382 ^Z^Zelt-rep-end
18383 @end smallexample
18384
18385 In both cases, @var{the-value} is the output for the value of the
18386 element and @var{whitespace} can contain spaces, tabs, and newlines. In
18387 the repeated case, @var{number-of-repetitions} is the number of
18388 consecutive array elements which contain that value, and
18389 @var{repetition-string} is a string which is designed to convey to the
18390 user that repetition is being depicted.
18391
18392 @findex array-section-end
18393 Once all the array elements have been output, the array annotation is
18394 ended with
18395
18396 @smallexample
18397 ^Z^Zarray-section-end
18398 @end smallexample
18399
18400 @node Frame Annotations
18401 @section Frames
18402
18403 @cindex annotations for frames
18404 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a frame, it annotates it. For example, this applies
18405 to frames printed when @value{GDBN} stops, output from commands such as
18406 @code{backtrace} or @code{up}, etc.
18407
18408 @findex frame-begin
18409 The frame annotation begins with
18410
18411 @smallexample
18412 ^Z^Zframe-begin @var{level} @var{address}
18413 @var{level-string}
18414 @end smallexample
18415
18416 @noindent
18417 where @var{level} is the number of the frame (0 is the innermost frame,
18418 and other frames have positive numbers), @var{address} is the address of
18419 the code executing in that frame, and @var{level-string} is a string
18420 designed to convey the level to the user. @var{address} is in the form
18421 @samp{0x} followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this
18422 does not depend on the language). The frame ends with
18423
18424 @findex frame-end
18425 @smallexample
18426 ^Z^Zframe-end
18427 @end smallexample
18428
18429 Between these annotations is the main body of the frame, which can
18430 consist of
18431
18432 @itemize @bullet
18433 @item
18434 @findex function-call
18435 @smallexample
18436 ^Z^Zfunction-call
18437 @var{function-call-string}
18438 @end smallexample
18439
18440 where @var{function-call-string} is text designed to convey to the user
18441 that this frame is associated with a function call made by @value{GDBN} to a
18442 function in the program being debugged.
18443
18444 @item
18445 @findex signal-handler-caller
18446 @smallexample
18447 ^Z^Zsignal-handler-caller
18448 @var{signal-handler-caller-string}
18449 @end smallexample
18450
18451 where @var{signal-handler-caller-string} is text designed to convey to
18452 the user that this frame is associated with whatever mechanism is used
18453 by this operating system to call a signal handler (it is the frame which
18454 calls the signal handler, not the frame for the signal handler itself).
18455
18456 @item
18457 A normal frame.
18458
18459 @findex frame-address
18460 @findex frame-address-end
18461 This can optionally (depending on whether this is thought of as
18462 interesting information for the user to see) begin with
18463
18464 @smallexample
18465 ^Z^Zframe-address
18466 @var{address}
18467 ^Z^Zframe-address-end
18468 @var{separator-string}
18469 @end smallexample
18470
18471 where @var{address} is the address executing in the frame (the same
18472 address as in the @code{frame-begin} annotation, but printed in a form
18473 which is intended for user consumption---in particular, the syntax varies
18474 depending on the language), and @var{separator-string} is a string
18475 intended to separate this address from what follows for the user's
18476 benefit.
18477
18478 @findex frame-function-name
18479 @findex frame-args
18480 Then comes
18481
18482 @smallexample
18483 ^Z^Zframe-function-name
18484 @var{function-name}
18485 ^Z^Zframe-args
18486 @var{arguments}
18487 @end smallexample
18488
18489 where @var{function-name} is the name of the function executing in the
18490 frame, or @samp{??} if not known, and @var{arguments} are the arguments
18491 to the frame, with parentheses around them (each argument is annotated
18492 individually as well, @pxref{Value Annotations}).
18493
18494 @findex frame-source-begin
18495 @findex frame-source-file
18496 @findex frame-source-file-end
18497 @findex frame-source-line
18498 @findex frame-source-end
18499 If source information is available, a reference to it is then printed:
18500
18501 @smallexample
18502 ^Z^Zframe-source-begin
18503 @var{source-intro-string}
18504 ^Z^Zframe-source-file
18505 @var{filename}
18506 ^Z^Zframe-source-file-end
18507 :
18508 ^Z^Zframe-source-line
18509 @var{line-number}
18510 ^Z^Zframe-source-end
18511 @end smallexample
18512
18513 where @var{source-intro-string} separates for the user's benefit the
18514 reference from the text which precedes it, @var{filename} is the name of
18515 the source file, and @var{line-number} is the line number within that
18516 file (the first line is line 1).
18517
18518 @findex frame-where
18519 If @value{GDBN} prints some information about where the frame is from (which
18520 library, which load segment, etc.; currently only done on the RS/6000),
18521 it is annotated with
18522
18523 @smallexample
18524 ^Z^Zframe-where
18525 @var{information}
18526 @end smallexample
18527
18528 Then, if source is to actually be displayed for this frame (for example,
18529 this is not true for output from the @code{backtrace} command), then a
18530 @code{source} annotation (@pxref{Source Annotations}) is displayed. Unlike
18531 most annotations, this is output instead of the normal text which would be
18532 output, not in addition.
18533 @end itemize
18534
18535 @node Displays
18536 @section Displays
18537
18538 @findex display-begin
18539 @findex display-number-end
18540 @findex display-format
18541 @findex display-expression
18542 @findex display-expression-end
18543 @findex display-value
18544 @findex display-end
18545 @cindex annotations for display
18546 When @value{GDBN} is told to display something using the @code{display} command,
18547 the results of the display are annotated:
18548
18549 @smallexample
18550 ^Z^Zdisplay-begin
18551 @var{number}
18552 ^Z^Zdisplay-number-end
18553 @var{number-separator}
18554 ^Z^Zdisplay-format
18555 @var{format}
18556 ^Z^Zdisplay-expression
18557 @var{expression}
18558 ^Z^Zdisplay-expression-end
18559 @var{expression-separator}
18560 ^Z^Zdisplay-value
18561 @var{value}
18562 ^Z^Zdisplay-end
18563 @end smallexample
18564
18565 @noindent
18566 where @var{number} is the number of the display, @var{number-separator}
18567 is intended to separate the number from what follows for the user,
18568 @var{format} includes information such as the size, format, or other
18569 information about how the value is being displayed, @var{expression} is
18570 the expression being displayed, @var{expression-separator} is intended
18571 to separate the expression from the text that follows for the user,
18572 and @var{value} is the actual value being displayed.
18573
18574 @node Prompting
18575 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
18576
18577 @cindex annotations for prompts
18578 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
18579 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
18580 over, etc.
18581
18582 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
18583 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
18584 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
18585 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
18586 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
18587 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
18588 features the following annotations:
18589
18590 @smallexample
18591 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18592 ^Z^Zprompt
18593 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18594 @end smallexample
18595
18596 The input types are
18597
18598 @table @code
18599 @findex pre-prompt
18600 @findex prompt
18601 @findex post-prompt
18602 @item prompt
18603 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
18604
18605 @findex pre-commands
18606 @findex commands
18607 @findex post-commands
18608 @item commands
18609 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
18610 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
18611
18612 @findex pre-overload-choice
18613 @findex overload-choice
18614 @findex post-overload-choice
18615 @item overload-choice
18616 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
18617
18618 @findex pre-query
18619 @findex query
18620 @findex post-query
18621 @item query
18622 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
18623
18624 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
18625 @findex prompt-for-continue
18626 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
18627 @item prompt-for-continue
18628 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
18629 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
18630 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
18631 presence of annotations.
18632 @end table
18633
18634 @node Errors
18635 @section Errors
18636 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
18637
18638 @findex quit
18639 @smallexample
18640 ^Z^Zquit
18641 @end smallexample
18642
18643 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
18644
18645 @findex error
18646 @smallexample
18647 ^Z^Zerror
18648 @end smallexample
18649
18650 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
18651
18652 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
18653 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
18654 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
18655 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
18656 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
18657 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
18658 to the top level.
18659
18660 @findex error-begin
18661 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
18662
18663 @smallexample
18664 ^Z^Zerror-begin
18665 @end smallexample
18666
18667 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
18668 message.
18669
18670 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
18671 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
18672 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
18673
18674 @node Breakpoint Info
18675 @section Information on Breakpoints
18676
18677 @cindex annotations for breakpoints
18678 The output from the @code{info breakpoints} command is annotated as follows:
18679
18680 @findex breakpoints-headers
18681 @findex breakpoints-table
18682 @smallexample
18683 ^Z^Zbreakpoints-headers
18684 @var{header-entry}
18685 ^Z^Zbreakpoints-table
18686 @end smallexample
18687
18688 @noindent
18689 where @var{header-entry} has the same syntax as an entry (see below) but
18690 instead of containing data, it contains strings which are intended to
18691 convey the meaning of each field to the user. This is followed by any
18692 number of entries. If a field does not apply for this entry, it is
18693 omitted. Fields may contain trailing whitespace. Each entry consists
18694 of:
18695
18696 @findex record
18697 @findex field
18698 @smallexample
18699 ^Z^Zrecord
18700 ^Z^Zfield 0
18701 @var{number}
18702 ^Z^Zfield 1
18703 @var{type}
18704 ^Z^Zfield 2
18705 @var{disposition}
18706 ^Z^Zfield 3
18707 @var{enable}
18708 ^Z^Zfield 4
18709 @var{address}
18710 ^Z^Zfield 5
18711 @var{what}
18712 ^Z^Zfield 6
18713 @var{frame}
18714 ^Z^Zfield 7
18715 @var{condition}
18716 ^Z^Zfield 8
18717 @var{ignore-count}
18718 ^Z^Zfield 9
18719 @var{commands}
18720 @end smallexample
18721
18722 Note that @var{address} is intended for user consumption---the syntax
18723 varies depending on the language.
18724
18725 The output ends with
18726
18727 @findex breakpoints-table-end
18728 @smallexample
18729 ^Z^Zbreakpoints-table-end
18730 @end smallexample
18731
18732 @node Invalidation
18733 @section Invalidation Notices
18734
18735 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
18736 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
18737 changed.
18738
18739 @table @code
18740 @findex frames-invalid
18741 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
18742
18743 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
18744 have changed.
18745
18746 @findex breakpoints-invalid
18747 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
18748
18749 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
18750 deleted a breakpoint.
18751 @end table
18752
18753 @node Annotations for Running
18754 @section Running the Program
18755 @cindex annotations for running programs
18756
18757 @findex starting
18758 @findex stopping
18759 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
18760 @code{step} or @code{continue},
18761
18762 @smallexample
18763 ^Z^Zstarting
18764 @end smallexample
18765
18766 is output. When the program stops,
18767
18768 @smallexample
18769 ^Z^Zstopped
18770 @end smallexample
18771
18772 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
18773 annotations describe how the program stopped.
18774
18775 @table @code
18776 @findex exited
18777 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
18778 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
18779 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
18780
18781 @findex signalled
18782 @findex signal-name
18783 @findex signal-name-end
18784 @findex signal-string
18785 @findex signal-string-end
18786 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
18787 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
18788 annotation continues:
18789
18790 @smallexample
18791 @var{intro-text}
18792 ^Z^Zsignal-name
18793 @var{name}
18794 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
18795 @var{middle-text}
18796 ^Z^Zsignal-string
18797 @var{string}
18798 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
18799 @var{end-text}
18800 @end smallexample
18801
18802 @noindent
18803 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
18804 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
18805 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
18806 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
18807 user's benefit and have no particular format.
18808
18809 @findex signal
18810 @item ^Z^Zsignal
18811 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
18812 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
18813 terminated with it.
18814
18815 @findex breakpoint
18816 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
18817 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
18818
18819 @findex watchpoint
18820 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
18821 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
18822 @end table
18823
18824 @node Source Annotations
18825 @section Displaying Source
18826 @cindex annotations for source display
18827
18828 @findex source
18829 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
18830
18831 @smallexample
18832 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
18833 @end smallexample
18834
18835 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
18836 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
18837 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
18838 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
18839 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
18840 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
18841 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
18842 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
18843 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
18844 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
18845 depend on the language).
18846
18847 @node TODO
18848 @section Annotations We Might Want in the Future
18849
18850 @format
18851 - target-invalid
18852 the target might have changed (registers, heap contents, or
18853 execution status). For performance, we might eventually want
18854 to hit `registers-invalid' and `all-registers-invalid' with
18855 greater precision
18856
18857 - systematic annotation for set/show parameters (including
18858 invalidation notices).
18859
18860 - similarly, `info' returns a list of candidates for invalidation
18861 notices.
18862 @end format
18863
18864 @node GDB Bugs
18865 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
18866 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
18867 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
18868
18869 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
18870
18871 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
18872 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
18873 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
18874 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
18875
18876 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
18877 information that enables us to fix the bug.
18878
18879 @menu
18880 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
18881 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
18882 @end menu
18883
18884 @node Bug Criteria
18885 @section Have you found a bug?
18886 @cindex bug criteria
18887
18888 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
18889
18890 @itemize @bullet
18891 @cindex fatal signal
18892 @cindex debugger crash
18893 @cindex crash of debugger
18894 @item
18895 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
18896 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
18897
18898 @cindex error on valid input
18899 @item
18900 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
18901 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
18902 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
18903
18904 @cindex invalid input
18905 @item
18906 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
18907 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
18908 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
18909 for traditional practice''.
18910
18911 @item
18912 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
18913 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
18914 @end itemize
18915
18916 @node Bug Reporting
18917 @section How to report bugs
18918 @cindex bug reports
18919 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
18920
18921 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
18922 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
18923 contact that organization first.
18924
18925 You can find contact information for many support companies and
18926 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
18927 distribution.
18928 @c should add a web page ref...
18929
18930 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
18931 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
18932 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
18933 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
18934 be used.
18935
18936 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
18937 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
18938 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
18939 @samp{bug-gdb}.
18940
18941 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
18942 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
18943 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
18944 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
18945 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
18946 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
18947 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
18948 bug reports to the mailing list.
18949
18950 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
18951 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
18952 fact or leave it out, state it!
18953
18954 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
18955 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
18956 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
18957 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
18958 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
18959 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
18960 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
18961 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
18962 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
18963
18964 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
18965 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
18966 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
18967 self-contained.
18968
18969 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
18970 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
18971 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
18972 bugs properly.
18973
18974 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
18975
18976 @itemize @bullet
18977 @item
18978 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
18979 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
18980 version}.
18981
18982 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
18983 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
18984
18985 @item
18986 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
18987 version number.
18988
18989 @item
18990 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
18991 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
18992
18993 @item
18994 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
18995 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
18996 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
18997 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
18998 compilers.
18999
19000 @item
19001 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
19002 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
19003 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
19004 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
19005
19006 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
19007 and then we might not encounter the bug.
19008
19009 @item
19010 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
19011 reproduce the bug.
19012
19013 @item
19014 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
19015 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
19016
19017 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
19018 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
19019 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
19020 a chance to make a mistake.
19021
19022 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
19023 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
19024 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
19025 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
19026 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
19027 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
19028 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
19029 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
19030
19031 @item
19032 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
19033 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
19034 it by context, not by line number.
19035
19036 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
19037 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
19038
19039 @end itemize
19040
19041 Here are some things that are not necessary:
19042
19043 @itemize @bullet
19044 @item
19045 A description of the envelope of the bug.
19046
19047 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
19048 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
19049 changes will not affect it.
19050
19051 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
19052 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
19053 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
19054 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
19055
19056 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
19057 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
19058 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
19059 less time, and so on.
19060
19061 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
19062 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
19063
19064 @item
19065 A patch for the bug.
19066
19067 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
19068 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
19069 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
19070 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
19071
19072 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
19073 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
19074 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
19075 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
19076
19077 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
19078 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
19079 help us to understand.
19080
19081 @item
19082 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
19083
19084 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
19085 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
19086 @end itemize
19087
19088 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
19089 @c and consists of the two following files:
19090 @c rluser.texinfo
19091 @c inc-hist.texinfo
19092 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
19093 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
19094 @include rluser.texinfo
19095 @include inc-hist.texinfo
19096
19097
19098 @node Formatting Documentation
19099 @appendix Formatting Documentation
19100
19101 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
19102 @cindex reference card
19103 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
19104 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
19105 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
19106 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
19107 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
19108 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
19109
19110 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
19111 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
19112
19113 @smallexample
19114 make refcard.dvi
19115 @end smallexample
19116
19117 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
19118 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
19119 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
19120 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
19121 your @sc{dvi} output program.
19122
19123 @cindex documentation
19124
19125 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
19126 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
19127 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
19128 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
19129 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
19130 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
19131
19132 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
19133 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
19134 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
19135 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
19136 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
19137 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
19138 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
19139 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
19140
19141 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
19142 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
19143 @code{makeinfo}.
19144
19145 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
19146 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
19147 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
19148
19149 @smallexample
19150 cd gdb
19151 make gdb.info
19152 @end smallexample
19153
19154 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
19155 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
19156 Texinfo definitions file.
19157
19158 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
19159 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
19160 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
19161 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
19162 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
19163 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
19164 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
19165
19166 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
19167 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
19168 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
19169 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
19170 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
19171 directory.
19172
19173 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
19174 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
19175 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
19176 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
19177
19178 @smallexample
19179 make gdb.dvi
19180 @end smallexample
19181
19182 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
19183
19184 @node Installing GDB
19185 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
19186 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
19187 @cindex installation
19188 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
19189
19190 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
19191 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
19192 build the @code{gdb} program.
19193 @iftex
19194 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
19195 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
19196 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
19197 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
19198 @end iftex
19199
19200 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
19201 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
19202 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
19203
19204 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
19205 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
19206
19207 @table @code
19208 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
19209 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
19210
19211 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
19212 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
19213
19214 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
19215 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
19216
19217 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
19218 @sc{gnu} include files
19219
19220 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
19221 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
19222
19223 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
19224 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
19225
19226 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
19227 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
19228
19229 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
19230 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
19231
19232 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
19233 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
19234 @end table
19235
19236 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
19237 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
19238 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
19239
19240 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
19241 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
19242 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
19243 argument.
19244
19245 For example:
19246
19247 @smallexample
19248 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19249 ./configure @var{host}
19250 make
19251 @end smallexample
19252
19253 @noindent
19254 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
19255 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
19256 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
19257 correct value by examining your system.)
19258
19259 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
19260 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
19261 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
19262 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
19263
19264 @need 750
19265 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
19266 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
19267 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
19268
19269 @smallexample
19270 sh configure @var{host}
19271 @end smallexample
19272
19273 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
19274 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
19275 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
19276 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
19277 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
19278
19279 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
19280 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
19281 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
19282 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
19283 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
19284 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
19285 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
19286 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
19287 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19288
19289 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
19290 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
19291 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
19292 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
19293 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
19294
19295 @menu
19296 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
19297 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
19298 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
19299 @end menu
19300
19301 @node Separate Objdir
19302 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
19303
19304 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
19305 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
19306 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
19307 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
19308 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
19309 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
19310 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
19311 program specified there.
19312
19313 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
19314 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
19315 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
19316 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
19317 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
19318 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
19319
19320 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
19321 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
19322
19323 @smallexample
19324 @group
19325 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
19326 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
19327 cd ../gdb-sun4
19328 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
19329 make
19330 @end group
19331 @end smallexample
19332
19333 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
19334 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
19335 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
19336 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
19337 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
19338 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
19339
19340 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
19341 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
19342 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
19343 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
19344 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
19345
19346 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
19347 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
19348 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
19349 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
19350 You specify a cross-debugging target by
19351 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
19352
19353 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
19354 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
19355 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
19356
19357 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
19358 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
19359 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
19360 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
19361 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
19362
19363 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
19364 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
19365 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
19366 with each other.
19367
19368 @node Config Names
19369 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
19370
19371 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
19372 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
19373 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
19374 of information in the following pattern:
19375
19376 @smallexample
19377 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
19378 @end smallexample
19379
19380 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
19381 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
19382 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
19383
19384 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
19385 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
19386 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
19387 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
19388 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
19389 abbreviations---for example:
19390
19391 @smallexample
19392 % sh config.sub i386-linux
19393 i386-pc-linux-gnu
19394 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
19395 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
19396 % sh config.sub hp9k700
19397 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
19398 % sh config.sub sun4
19399 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
19400 % sh config.sub sun3
19401 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
19402 % sh config.sub i986v
19403 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
19404 @end smallexample
19405
19406 @noindent
19407 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
19408 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
19409
19410 @node Configure Options
19411 @section @code{configure} options
19412
19413 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
19414 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
19415 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
19416 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
19417
19418 @smallexample
19419 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
19420 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19421 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19422 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
19423 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
19424 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
19425 @var{host}
19426 @end smallexample
19427
19428 @noindent
19429 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
19430 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
19431 @samp{--}.
19432
19433 @table @code
19434 @item --help
19435 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
19436
19437 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
19438 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
19439 @file{@var{dir}}.
19440
19441 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
19442 Configure the source to install programs under directory
19443 @file{@var{dir}}.
19444
19445 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
19446 @need 2000
19447 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
19448 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
19449 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
19450 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
19451 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
19452 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
19453 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
19454 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
19455 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
19456 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
19457 @var{dirname}.
19458
19459 @item --norecursion
19460 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
19461 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
19462
19463 @item --target=@var{target}
19464 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
19465 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
19466 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
19467
19468 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
19469
19470 @item @var{host} @dots{}
19471 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
19472
19473 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
19474 @end table
19475
19476 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
19477 needed for special purposes only.
19478
19479 @node Maintenance Commands
19480 @appendix Maintenance Commands
19481 @cindex maintenance commands
19482 @cindex internal commands
19483
19484 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
19485 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
19486 These commands are provided here for reference.
19487
19488 @table @code
19489 @kindex maint info breakpoints
19490 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
19491 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
19492 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
19493 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
19494 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
19495 is shown:
19496
19497 @table @code
19498 @item breakpoint
19499 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
19500
19501 @item watchpoint
19502 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
19503
19504 @item longjmp
19505 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
19506 @code{longjmp} calls.
19507
19508 @item longjmp resume
19509 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
19510
19511 @item until
19512 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
19513
19514 @item finish
19515 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
19516
19517 @item shlib events
19518 Shared library events.
19519
19520 @end table
19521
19522 @kindex maint internal-error
19523 @kindex maint internal-warning
19524 @item maint internal-error
19525 @itemx maint internal-warning
19526 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
19527 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
19528 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
19529 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
19530 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
19531 @value{GDBN} session.
19532
19533 @smallexample
19534 (gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
19535 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
19536 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
19537 debugging may prove unreliable.
19538 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19539 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19540 (gdb)
19541 @end smallexample
19542
19543 Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
19544 warning message.
19545
19546 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
19547 @item maint print dummy-frames
19548
19549 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
19550
19551 @smallexample
19552 (gdb) @kbd{b add}
19553 @dots{}
19554 (gdb) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
19555 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
19556 58 return (a + b);
19557 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
19558 @dots{}
19559 (gdb) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
19560 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
19561 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
19562 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
19563 (gdb)
19564 @end smallexample
19565
19566 Takes an optional file parameter.
19567
19568 @kindex maint print registers
19569 @kindex maint print raw-registers
19570 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
19571 @kindex maint print register-groups
19572 @item maint print registers
19573 @itemx maint print raw-registers
19574 @itemx maint print cooked-registers
19575 @itemx maint print register-groups
19576 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
19577
19578 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
19579 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
19580 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
19581 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
19582 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
19583 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
19584
19585 Takes an optional file parameter.
19586
19587 @kindex maint print reggroups
19588 @item maint print reggroups
19589 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
19590
19591 Takes an optional file parameter.
19592
19593 @smallexample
19594 (gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
19595 Group Type
19596 general user
19597 float user
19598 all user
19599 vector user
19600 system user
19601 save internal
19602 restore internal
19603 @end smallexample
19604
19605 @kindex maint set profile
19606 @kindex maint show profile
19607 @cindex profiling GDB
19608 @item maint set profile
19609 @itemx maint show profile
19610 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
19611
19612 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
19613 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
19614 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
19615 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
19616 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
19617 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
19618 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
19619
19620 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
19621 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
19622
19623 @end table
19624
19625
19626 @node Remote Protocol
19627 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
19628
19629 @menu
19630 * Overview::
19631 * Packets::
19632 * Stop Reply Packets::
19633 * General Query Packets::
19634 * Register Packet Format::
19635 * Examples::
19636 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
19637 @end menu
19638
19639 @node Overview
19640 @section Overview
19641
19642 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
19643 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
19644 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
19645 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
19646
19647 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
19648 transmitted and received data respectfully.
19649
19650 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
19651 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
19652 @cindex remote serial protocol
19653 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
19654 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
19655 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
19656 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
19657
19658 @smallexample
19659 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19660 @end smallexample
19661 @noindent
19662
19663 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
19664 @noindent
19665 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
19666 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
19667 eight bit unsigned checksum).
19668
19669 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
19670 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
19671
19672 @smallexample
19673 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19674 @end smallexample
19675
19676 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
19677 @noindent
19678 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
19679 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
19680 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
19681
19682 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
19683 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
19684 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
19685 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
19686 retransmission):
19687
19688 @smallexample
19689 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19690 <- @code{+}
19691 @end smallexample
19692 @noindent
19693
19694 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
19695 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
19696 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
19697 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
19698
19699 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
19700 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
19701 exceptions).
19702
19703 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
19704 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
19705 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
19706 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
19707
19708 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
19709 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
19710 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
19711
19712 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
19713 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
19714 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
19715 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
19716 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
19717 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
19718 value greater than 126 should not be used.
19719
19720 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
19721 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
19722 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
19723
19724 So:
19725 @smallexample
19726 "@code{0* }"
19727 @end smallexample
19728 @noindent
19729 means the same as "0000".
19730
19731 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
19732 error number. That number is not well defined.
19733
19734 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
19735 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
19736 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
19737 on that response.
19738
19739 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
19740 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
19741 optional.
19742
19743 @node Packets
19744 @section Packets
19745
19746 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
19747 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
19748
19749 @table @r
19750
19751 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
19752 @cindex @code{!} packet
19753
19754 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
19755 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
19756 debugged.
19757
19758 Reply:
19759 @table @samp
19760 @item OK
19761 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
19762 @end table
19763
19764 @item @code{?} --- last signal
19765 @cindex @code{?} packet
19766
19767 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
19768 step and continue.
19769
19770 Reply:
19771 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19772
19773 @item @code{a} --- reserved
19774
19775 Reserved for future use.
19776
19777 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
19778 @cindex @code{A} packet
19779
19780 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
19781 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
19782 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
19783
19784 Reply:
19785 @table @samp
19786 @item OK
19787 @item E@var{NN}
19788 @end table
19789
19790 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
19791 @cindex @code{b} packet
19792
19793 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
19794
19795 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
19796 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
19797 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
19798
19799 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
19800 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
19801 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
19802 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
19803 of view, nothing actually happened.}
19804
19805 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
19806 @cindex @code{B} packet
19807
19808 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
19809 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
19810
19811 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
19812 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
19813
19814 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
19815 @cindex @code{c} packet
19816
19817 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19818 current address.
19819
19820 Reply:
19821 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19822
19823 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
19824 @cindex @code{C} packet
19825
19826 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
19827 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
19828
19829 Reply:
19830 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19831
19832 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
19833 @cindex @code{d} packet
19834
19835 Toggle debug flag.
19836
19837 @item @code{D} --- detach
19838 @cindex @code{D} packet
19839
19840 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
19841 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
19842
19843 Reply:
19844 @table @samp
19845 @item @emph{no response}
19846 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
19847 @end table
19848
19849 @item @code{e} --- reserved
19850
19851 Reserved for future use.
19852
19853 @item @code{E} --- reserved
19854
19855 Reserved for future use.
19856
19857 @item @code{f} --- reserved
19858
19859 Reserved for future use.
19860
19861 @item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
19862 @cindex @code{F} packet
19863
19864 This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
19865 sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
19866 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
19867
19868 @item @code{g} --- read registers
19869 @anchor{read registers packet}
19870 @cindex @code{g} packet
19871
19872 Read general registers.
19873
19874 Reply:
19875 @table @samp
19876 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19877 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
19878 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
19879 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
19880 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
19881 and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
19882 @code{g} packets is specified below.
19883 @item E@var{NN}
19884 for an error.
19885 @end table
19886
19887 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
19888 @cindex @code{G} packet
19889
19890 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
19891 data.
19892
19893 Reply:
19894 @table @samp
19895 @item OK
19896 for success
19897 @item E@var{NN}
19898 for an error
19899 @end table
19900
19901 @item @code{h} --- reserved
19902
19903 Reserved for future use.
19904
19905 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
19906 @cindex @code{H} packet
19907
19908 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
19909 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
19910 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
19911 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
19912 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
19913
19914 Reply:
19915 @table @samp
19916 @item OK
19917 for success
19918 @item E@var{NN}
19919 for an error
19920 @end table
19921
19922 @c FIXME: JTC:
19923 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
19924 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
19925 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
19926 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
19927 @c described. For example:
19928 @c
19929 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19930 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
19931 @c otherwise returns current registers.
19932 @c
19933 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19934 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
19935 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
19936
19937 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
19938 @anchor{cycle step packet}
19939 @cindex @code{i} packet
19940
19941 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
19942 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
19943 step starting at that address.
19944
19945 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
19946 @cindex @code{I} packet
19947
19948 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
19949
19950 @item @code{j} --- reserved
19951
19952 Reserved for future use.
19953
19954 @item @code{J} --- reserved
19955
19956 Reserved for future use.
19957
19958 @item @code{k} --- kill request
19959 @cindex @code{k} packet
19960
19961 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
19962 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
19963 thread?)}.
19964
19965 @item @code{K} --- reserved
19966
19967 Reserved for future use.
19968
19969 @item @code{l} --- reserved
19970
19971 Reserved for future use.
19972
19973 @item @code{L} --- reserved
19974
19975 Reserved for future use.
19976
19977 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
19978 @cindex @code{m} packet
19979
19980 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
19981 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
19982 assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
19983 transfer mechanism is needed.}
19984
19985 Reply:
19986 @table @samp
19987 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19988 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
19989 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
19990 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
19991 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
19992 needed.}
19993 @item E@var{NN}
19994 @var{NN} is errno
19995 @end table
19996
19997 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
19998 @cindex @code{M} packet
19999
20000 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
20001 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
20002
20003 Reply:
20004 @table @samp
20005 @item OK
20006 for success
20007 @item E@var{NN}
20008 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
20009 written).
20010 @end table
20011
20012 @item @code{n} --- reserved
20013
20014 Reserved for future use.
20015
20016 @item @code{N} --- reserved
20017
20018 Reserved for future use.
20019
20020 @item @code{o} --- reserved
20021
20022 Reserved for future use.
20023
20024 @item @code{O} --- reserved
20025
20026 Reserved for future use.
20027
20028 @item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
20029 @cindex @code{p} packet
20030
20031 @xref{write register packet}.
20032
20033 Reply:
20034 @table @samp
20035 @item @var{r@dots{}.}
20036 The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
20037 @end table
20038
20039 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
20040 @anchor{write register packet}
20041 @cindex @code{P} packet
20042
20043 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
20044 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
20045
20046 Reply:
20047 @table @samp
20048 @item OK
20049 for success
20050 @item E@var{NN}
20051 for an error
20052 @end table
20053
20054 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
20055 @anchor{general query packet}
20056 @cindex @code{q} packet
20057
20058 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
20059 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
20060 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
20061 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
20062 that they match the full @var{query} name.
20063
20064 Reply:
20065 @table @samp
20066 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
20067 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
20068 @item E@var{NN}
20069 error reply
20070 @item
20071 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
20072 @end table
20073
20074 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
20075 @cindex @code{Q} packet
20076
20077 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
20078
20079 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
20080
20081 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
20082 @cindex @code{r} packet
20083
20084 Reset the entire system.
20085
20086 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
20087 @cindex @code{R} packet
20088
20089 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
20090 This packet is only available in extended mode.
20091
20092 Reply:
20093 @table @samp
20094 @item @emph{no reply}
20095 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
20096 @end table
20097
20098 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
20099 @cindex @code{s} packet
20100
20101 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
20102 same address.
20103
20104 Reply:
20105 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
20106
20107 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
20108 @anchor{step with signal packet}
20109 @cindex @code{S} packet
20110
20111 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
20112
20113 Reply:
20114 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
20115
20116 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
20117 @cindex @code{t} packet
20118
20119 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
20120 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
20121 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
20122
20123 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
20124 @cindex @code{T} packet
20125
20126 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
20127
20128 Reply:
20129 @table @samp
20130 @item OK
20131 thread is still alive
20132 @item E@var{NN}
20133 thread is dead
20134 @end table
20135
20136 @item @code{u} --- reserved
20137
20138 Reserved for future use.
20139
20140 @item @code{U} --- reserved
20141
20142 Reserved for future use.
20143
20144 @item @code{v} --- reserved
20145
20146 Reserved for future use.
20147
20148 @item @code{V} --- reserved
20149
20150 Reserved for future use.
20151
20152 @item @code{w} --- reserved
20153
20154 Reserved for future use.
20155
20156 @item @code{W} --- reserved
20157
20158 Reserved for future use.
20159
20160 @item @code{x} --- reserved
20161
20162 Reserved for future use.
20163
20164 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
20165 @cindex @code{X} packet
20166
20167 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
20168 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
20169 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
20170
20171 Reply:
20172 @table @samp
20173 @item OK
20174 for success
20175 @item E@var{NN}
20176 for an error
20177 @end table
20178
20179 @item @code{y} --- reserved
20180
20181 Reserved for future use.
20182
20183 @item @code{Y} reserved
20184
20185 Reserved for future use.
20186
20187 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20188 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20189 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
20190 @cindex @code{z} packet
20191 @cindex @code{Z} packets
20192
20193 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
20194 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
20195 @var{length} bytes.
20196
20197 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
20198 separately.
20199
20200 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
20201 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
20202 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
20203 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
20204 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
20205 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
20206
20207 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20208 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20209 @cindex @code{z0} packet
20210 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
20211
20212 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
20213 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20214
20215 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
20216 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
20217 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
20218 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
20219 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
20220
20221 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
20222 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
20223 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
20224 target, is not defined.}
20225
20226 Reply:
20227 @table @samp
20228 @item OK
20229 success
20230 @item
20231 not supported
20232 @item E@var{NN}
20233 for an error
20234 @end table
20235
20236 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20237 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
20238 @cindex @code{z1} packet
20239 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
20240
20241 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
20242 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
20243
20244 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
20245 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
20246
20247 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
20248 movement.}
20249
20250 Reply:
20251 @table @samp
20252 @item OK
20253 success
20254 @item
20255 not supported
20256 @item E@var{NN}
20257 for an error
20258 @end table
20259
20260 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20261 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20262 @cindex @code{z2} packet
20263 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
20264
20265 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
20266
20267 Reply:
20268 @table @samp
20269 @item OK
20270 success
20271 @item
20272 not supported
20273 @item E@var{NN}
20274 for an error
20275 @end table
20276
20277 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20278 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20279 @cindex @code{z3} packet
20280 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
20281
20282 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
20283
20284 Reply:
20285 @table @samp
20286 @item OK
20287 success
20288 @item
20289 not supported
20290 @item E@var{NN}
20291 for an error
20292 @end table
20293
20294 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20295 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
20296 @cindex @code{z4} packet
20297 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
20298
20299 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
20300
20301 Reply:
20302 @table @samp
20303 @item OK
20304 success
20305 @item
20306 not supported
20307 @item E@var{NN}
20308 for an error
20309 @end table
20310
20311 @end table
20312
20313 @node Stop Reply Packets
20314 @section Stop Reply Packets
20315 @cindex stop reply packets
20316
20317 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
20318 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
20319 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
20320 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
20321 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
20322 conventions is used.
20323
20324 @table @samp
20325
20326 @item S@var{AA}
20327 @var{AA} is the signal number
20328
20329 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
20330 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
20331
20332 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
20333 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
20334 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
20335 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
20336 @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
20337 integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
20338 @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
20339 to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
20340
20341 @item W@var{AA}
20342
20343 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
20344 applicable to certain targets.
20345
20346 @item X@var{AA}
20347
20348 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
20349
20350 @item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
20351
20352 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
20353 @code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
20354 base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
20355 The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
20356 the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
20357 is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
20358
20359 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
20360
20361 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
20362 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
20363 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
20364
20365 @item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20366
20367 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
20368 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
20369 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
20370 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
20371 system calls.
20372
20373 @var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
20374 system call.
20375
20376 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
20377 a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
20378 an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
20379 packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
20380 @samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
20381 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
20382
20383 @end table
20384
20385 @node General Query Packets
20386 @section General Query Packets
20387
20388 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
20389
20390 @table @r
20391
20392 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
20393
20394 Return the current thread id.
20395
20396 Reply:
20397 @table @samp
20398 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
20399 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
20400 @item *
20401 Any other reply implies the old pid.
20402 @end table
20403
20404 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
20405
20406 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
20407
20408 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
20409 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
20410 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
20411 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
20412 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
20413 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
20414
20415 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
20416
20417 Reply:
20418 @table @samp
20419 @item @code{m}@var{id}
20420 A single thread id
20421 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
20422 a comma-separated list of thread ids
20423 @item @code{l}
20424 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
20425 @end table
20426
20427 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
20428 more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
20429 will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
20430 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
20431 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
20432
20433 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
20434
20435 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
20436 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
20437 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
20438 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
20439 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
20440 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
20441 Mutex''.
20442
20443 Reply:
20444 @table @samp
20445 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
20446 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
20447 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
20448 attributes.
20449 @end table
20450
20451 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
20452
20453 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
20454 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
20455 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
20456 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
20457 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
20458 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
20459
20460 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
20461 (see above).
20462
20463 Reply:
20464 @table @samp
20465 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
20466 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
20467 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
20468 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
20469 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
20470 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
20471 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
20472 @end table
20473
20474 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
20475
20476 Reply:
20477 @table @samp
20478 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20479 An error (such as memory fault)
20480 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
20481 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
20482 @end table
20483
20484 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
20485
20486 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
20487 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
20488 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
20489 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
20490
20491 Reply:
20492 @table @samp
20493 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
20494 @end table
20495
20496 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
20497
20498 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
20499 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
20500
20501 Reply:
20502 @table @samp
20503 @item *
20504 @end table
20505
20506 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
20507
20508 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
20509
20510 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
20511 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
20512 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
20513 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
20514 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
20515 interpreter may have security implications}.
20516
20517 Reply:
20518 @table @samp
20519 @item OK
20520 A command response with no output.
20521 @item @var{OUTPUT}
20522 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
20523 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20524 Indicate a badly formed request.
20525 @item @samp{}
20526 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
20527 @end table
20528
20529 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
20530
20531 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
20532 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
20533
20534 Reply:
20535 @table @samp
20536 @item @code{OK}
20537 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20538 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20539 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
20540 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
20541 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
20542 @end table
20543
20544 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
20545
20546 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
20547
20548 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
20549 target has previously requested.
20550
20551 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
20552 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
20553 will be empty.
20554
20555 Reply:
20556 @table @samp
20557 @item @code{OK}
20558 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20559 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20560 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
20561 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
20562 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
20563 @end table
20564
20565 @end table
20566
20567 @node Register Packet Format
20568 @section Register Packet Format
20569
20570 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
20571 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
20572 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
20573 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
20574 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
20575 most-significant - least-significant.
20576
20577 @table @r
20578
20579 @item MIPS32
20580
20581 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
20582 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
20583 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
20584
20585 @item MIPS64
20586
20587 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
20588 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
20589 as @code{MIPS32}.
20590
20591 @end table
20592
20593 @node Examples
20594 @section Examples
20595
20596 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
20597 does not get any direct output:
20598
20599 @smallexample
20600 -> @code{R00}
20601 <- @code{+}
20602 @emph{target restarts}
20603 -> @code{?}
20604 <- @code{+}
20605 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20606 -> @code{+}
20607 @end smallexample
20608
20609 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
20610
20611 @smallexample
20612 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
20613 <- @code{+}
20614 -> @code{s}
20615 <- @code{+}
20616 @emph{time passes}
20617 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20618 -> @code{+}
20619 -> @code{g}
20620 <- @code{+}
20621 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
20622 -> @code{+}
20623 @end smallexample
20624
20625 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
20626 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
20627 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
20628
20629 @menu
20630 * File-I/O Overview::
20631 * Protocol basics::
20632 * The `F' request packet::
20633 * The `F' reply packet::
20634 * Memory transfer::
20635 * The Ctrl-C message::
20636 * Console I/O::
20637 * The isatty call::
20638 * The system call::
20639 * List of supported calls::
20640 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
20641 * Constants::
20642 * File-I/O Examples::
20643 @end menu
20644
20645 @node File-I/O Overview
20646 @subsection File-I/O Overview
20647 @cindex file-i/o overview
20648
20649 The File I/O remote protocol extension (short: File-I/O) allows the
20650 target to use the hosts file system and console I/O when calling various
20651 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
20652 remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
20653 actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
20654 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
20655
20656 The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
20657 it's own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
20658 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
20659 translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
20660 when data is transmitted.
20661
20662 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
20663 when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
20664 packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
20665 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
20666 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
20667 is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
20668
20669 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
20670 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
20671 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
20672 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
20673 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
20674
20675 @smallexample
20676 (gdb) continue
20677 <- target requests 'system call X'
20678 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
20679 -> GDB returns result
20680 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
20681 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
20682 @end smallexample
20683
20684 The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
20685 for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
20686 named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
20687 system are not supported by this protocol.
20688
20689 @node Protocol basics
20690 @subsection Protocol basics
20691 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
20692
20693 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
20694 as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
20695 @value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
20696 File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
20697 of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
20698 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
20699 to call the appropriate host system call:
20700
20701 @itemize @bullet
20702 @item
20703 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
20704
20705 @item
20706 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
20707 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
20708 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
20709 Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
20710
20711 @end itemize
20712
20713 At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
20714
20715 @itemize @bullet
20716 @item
20717 If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
20718 to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
20719 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
20720 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
20721 packet.
20722
20723 @item
20724 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
20725 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
20726
20727 @item
20728 @value{GDBN} calls the system call
20729
20730 @item
20731 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
20732
20733 @item
20734 If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
20735 a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
20736 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
20737 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
20738 packet.
20739
20740 @end itemize
20741
20742 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
20743 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
20744
20745 @itemize @bullet
20746 @item
20747 Return value.
20748
20749 @item
20750 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
20751
20752 @item
20753 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
20754
20755 @end itemize
20756
20757 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
20758 the latest continue or step action.
20759
20760 @node The `F' request packet
20761 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
20762 @cindex file-i/o request packet
20763 @cindex @code{F} request packet
20764
20765 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
20766
20767 @table @samp
20768
20769 @smallexample
20770 @code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20771 @end smallexample
20772
20773 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
20774 This is just the name of the function.
20775
20776 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
20777
20778 @end table
20779
20780 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
20781 of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
20782 datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
20783 of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
20784 from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
20785 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
20786
20787 @node The `F' reply packet
20788 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
20789 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
20790 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
20791
20792 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
20793
20794 @table @samp
20795
20796 @smallexample
20797 @code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
20798 @end smallexample
20799
20800 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
20801
20802 @var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
20803 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
20804
20805 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
20806 case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
20807 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
20808
20809 @smallexample
20810 F0,0,C
20811 @end smallexample
20812
20813 @noindent
20814 or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
20815
20816 @smallexample
20817 F-1,4,C
20818 @end smallexample
20819
20820 @noindent
20821 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
20822
20823 @end table
20824
20825 @node Memory transfer
20826 @subsection Memory transfer
20827 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
20828
20829 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
20830 a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
20831 all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
20832 the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
20833 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
20834 data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
20835
20836 @node The Ctrl-C message
20837 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
20838 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
20839
20840 A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
20841 reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
20842 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
20843 interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
20844 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
20845 packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
20846 state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
20847 not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
20848
20849 @itemize @bullet
20850 @item
20851 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
20852
20853 @item
20854 The system call on the host has been finished.
20855
20856 @end itemize
20857
20858 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
20859 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
20860 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
20861 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
20862 system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
20863 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
20864
20865 @value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
20866 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
20867 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
20868 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
20869 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
20870 The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
20871 or the full action has been completed.
20872
20873 @node Console I/O
20874 @subsection Console I/O
20875 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
20876
20877 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
20878 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
20879 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
20880 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
20881 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
20882 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
20883 conditions is met:
20884
20885 @itemize @bullet
20886 @item
20887 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
20888 @code{read}
20889 system call is treated as finished.
20890
20891 @item
20892 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
20893 line feed.
20894
20895 @item
20896 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
20897 character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
20898
20899 @end itemize
20900
20901 If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
20902 the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
20903 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
20904 is stopped on users request.
20905
20906 @node The isatty call
20907 @subsection The isatty(3) call
20908 @cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
20909
20910 A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
20911 is implemented as it's own call inside of this protocol. It returns
20912 1 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
20913 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
20914 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
20915 needed.
20916
20917 @node The system call
20918 @subsection The system(3) call
20919 @cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
20920
20921 The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
20922 is implemented as it's own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
20923 task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
20924 call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
20925 to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
20926 in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
20927 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
20928
20929 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is refused to be called
20930 by @value{GDBN} by default. The user has to allow this call explicitly by
20931 entering
20932
20933 @table @samp
20934 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 1
20935 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1}
20936 @end table
20937
20938 Disabling the @code{system} call is done by
20939
20940 @table @samp
20941 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 0
20942 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 0}
20943 @end table
20944
20945 The current setting is shown by typing
20946
20947 @table @samp
20948 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
20949 @item @code{show remote system-call-allowed}
20950 @end table
20951
20952 @node List of supported calls
20953 @subsection List of supported calls
20954 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
20955
20956 @menu
20957 * open::
20958 * close::
20959 * read::
20960 * write::
20961 * lseek::
20962 * rename::
20963 * unlink::
20964 * stat/fstat::
20965 * gettimeofday::
20966 * isatty::
20967 * system::
20968 @end menu
20969
20970 @node open
20971 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
20972 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
20973
20974 @smallexample
20975 @exdent Synopsis:
20976 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
20977 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
20978
20979 @exdent Request:
20980 Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
20981 @end smallexample
20982
20983 @noindent
20984 @code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20985
20986 @table @code
20987 @item O_CREAT
20988 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
20989 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
20990 are concerned.
20991
20992 @item O_EXCL
20993 When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
20994 an error and open() fails.
20995
20996 @item O_TRUNC
20997 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
20998 writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
20999 truncated to length 0.
21000
21001 @item O_APPEND
21002 The file is opened in append mode.
21003
21004 @item O_RDONLY
21005 The file is opened for reading only.
21006
21007 @item O_WRONLY
21008 The file is opened for writing only.
21009
21010 @item O_RDWR
21011 The file is opened for reading and writing.
21012
21013 @noindent
21014 Each other bit is silently ignored.
21015
21016 @end table
21017
21018 @noindent
21019 @code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
21020
21021 @table @code
21022 @item S_IRUSR
21023 User has read permission.
21024
21025 @item S_IWUSR
21026 User has write permission.
21027
21028 @item S_IRGRP
21029 Group has read permission.
21030
21031 @item S_IWGRP
21032 Group has write permission.
21033
21034 @item S_IROTH
21035 Others have read permission.
21036
21037 @item S_IWOTH
21038 Others have write permission.
21039
21040 @noindent
21041 Each other bit is silently ignored.
21042
21043 @end table
21044
21045 @smallexample
21046 @exdent Return value:
21047 open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
21048 occured.
21049
21050 @exdent Errors:
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053 @table @code
21054 @item EEXIST
21055 pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
21056
21057 @item EISDIR
21058 pathname refers to a directory.
21059
21060 @item EACCES
21061 The requested access is not allowed.
21062
21063 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21064 pathname was too long.
21065
21066 @item ENOENT
21067 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21068
21069 @item ENODEV
21070 pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
21071
21072 @item EROFS
21073 pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
21074 write access was requested.
21075
21076 @item EFAULT
21077 pathname is an invalid pointer value.
21078
21079 @item ENOSPC
21080 No space on device to create the file.
21081
21082 @item EMFILE
21083 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
21084
21085 @item ENFILE
21086 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
21087 has been reached.
21088
21089 @item EINTR
21090 The call was interrupted by the user.
21091 @end table
21092
21093 @node close
21094 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
21095 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
21096
21097 @smallexample
21098 @exdent Synopsis:
21099 int close(int fd);
21100
21101 @exdent Request:
21102 Fclose,fd
21103
21104 @exdent Return value:
21105 close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
21106
21107 @exdent Errors:
21108 @end smallexample
21109
21110 @table @code
21111 @item EBADF
21112 fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
21113
21114 @item EINTR
21115 The call was interrupted by the user.
21116 @end table
21117
21118 @node read
21119 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
21120 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
21121
21122 @smallexample
21123 @exdent Synopsis:
21124 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
21125
21126 @exdent Request:
21127 Fread,fd,bufptr,count
21128
21129 @exdent Return value:
21130 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
21131 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
21132 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
21133
21134 @exdent Errors:
21135 @end smallexample
21136
21137 @table @code
21138 @item EBADF
21139 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
21140 reading.
21141
21142 @item EFAULT
21143 buf is an invalid pointer value.
21144
21145 @item EINTR
21146 The call was interrupted by the user.
21147 @end table
21148
21149 @node write
21150 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
21151 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
21152
21153 @smallexample
21154 @exdent Synopsis:
21155 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
21156
21157 @exdent Request:
21158 Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
21159
21160 @exdent Return value:
21161 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
21162 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
21163 is returned.
21164
21165 @exdent Errors:
21166 @end smallexample
21167
21168 @table @code
21169 @item EBADF
21170 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
21171 writing.
21172
21173 @item EFAULT
21174 buf is an invalid pointer value.
21175
21176 @item EFBIG
21177 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
21178 host specific maximum file size allowed.
21179
21180 @item ENOSPC
21181 No space on device to write the data.
21182
21183 @item EINTR
21184 The call was interrupted by the user.
21185 @end table
21186
21187 @node lseek
21188 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
21189 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
21190
21191 @smallexample
21192 @exdent Synopsis:
21193 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
21194
21195 @exdent Request:
21196 Flseek,fd,offset,flag
21197 @end smallexample
21198
21199 @code{flag} is one of:
21200
21201 @table @code
21202 @item SEEK_SET
21203 The offset is set to offset bytes.
21204
21205 @item SEEK_CUR
21206 The offset is set to its current location plus offset
21207 bytes.
21208
21209 @item SEEK_END
21210 The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
21211 bytes.
21212 @end table
21213
21214 @smallexample
21215 @exdent Return value:
21216 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
21217 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
21218 value of -1 is returned.
21219
21220 @exdent Errors:
21221 @end smallexample
21222
21223 @table @code
21224 @item EBADF
21225 fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
21226
21227 @item ESPIPE
21228 fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
21229
21230 @item EINVAL
21231 flag is not a proper value.
21232
21233 @item EINTR
21234 The call was interrupted by the user.
21235 @end table
21236
21237 @node rename
21238 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
21239 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
21240
21241 @smallexample
21242 @exdent Synopsis:
21243 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
21244
21245 @exdent Request:
21246 Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
21247
21248 @exdent Return value:
21249 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21250
21251 @exdent Errors:
21252 @end smallexample
21253
21254 @table @code
21255 @item EISDIR
21256 newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
21257 directory.
21258
21259 @item EEXIST
21260 newpath is a non-empty directory.
21261
21262 @item EBUSY
21263 oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
21264 process.
21265
21266 @item EINVAL
21267 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
21268 of itself.
21269
21270 @item ENOTDIR
21271 A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
21272 path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
21273 and newpath exists but is not a directory.
21274
21275 @item EFAULT
21276 oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
21277
21278 @item EACCES
21279 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21280
21281 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21282
21283 oldpath or newpath was too long.
21284
21285 @item ENOENT
21286 A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
21287
21288 @item EROFS
21289 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21290
21291 @item ENOSPC
21292 The device containing the file has no room for the new
21293 directory entry.
21294
21295 @item EINTR
21296 The call was interrupted by the user.
21297 @end table
21298
21299 @node unlink
21300 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
21301 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
21302
21303 @smallexample
21304 @exdent Synopsis:
21305 int unlink(const char *pathname);
21306
21307 @exdent Request:
21308 Funlink,pathnameptr/len
21309
21310 @exdent Return value:
21311 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21312
21313 @exdent Errors:
21314 @end smallexample
21315
21316 @table @code
21317 @item EACCES
21318 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21319
21320 @item EPERM
21321 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
21322
21323 @item EBUSY
21324 The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
21325 being used by another process.
21326
21327 @item EFAULT
21328 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21329
21330 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21331 pathname was too long.
21332
21333 @item ENOENT
21334 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
21335
21336 @item ENOTDIR
21337 A component of the path is not a directory.
21338
21339 @item EROFS
21340 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
21341
21342 @item EINTR
21343 The call was interrupted by the user.
21344 @end table
21345
21346 @node stat/fstat
21347 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
21348 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
21349 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
21350
21351 @smallexample
21352 @exdent Synopsis:
21353 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
21354 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
21355
21356 @exdent Request:
21357 Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
21358 Ffstat,fd,bufptr
21359
21360 @exdent Return value:
21361 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21362
21363 @exdent Errors:
21364 @end smallexample
21365
21366 @table @code
21367 @item EBADF
21368 fd is not a valid open file.
21369
21370 @item ENOENT
21371 A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
21372 path is an empty string.
21373
21374 @item ENOTDIR
21375 A component of the path is not a directory.
21376
21377 @item EFAULT
21378 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21379
21380 @item EACCES
21381 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21382
21383 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21384 pathname was too long.
21385
21386 @item EINTR
21387 The call was interrupted by the user.
21388 @end table
21389
21390 @node gettimeofday
21391 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
21392 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
21393
21394 @smallexample
21395 @exdent Synopsis:
21396 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
21397
21398 @exdent Request:
21399 Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
21400
21401 @exdent Return value:
21402 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
21403
21404 @exdent Errors:
21405 @end smallexample
21406
21407 @table @code
21408 @item EINVAL
21409 tz is a non-NULL pointer.
21410
21411 @item EFAULT
21412 tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
21413 @end table
21414
21415 @node isatty
21416 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
21417 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
21418
21419 @smallexample
21420 @exdent Synopsis:
21421 int isatty(int fd);
21422
21423 @exdent Request:
21424 Fisatty,fd
21425
21426 @exdent Return value:
21427 Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
21428
21429 @exdent Errors:
21430 @end smallexample
21431
21432 @table @code
21433 @item EINTR
21434 The call was interrupted by the user.
21435 @end table
21436
21437 @node system
21438 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
21439 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
21440
21441 @smallexample
21442 @exdent Synopsis:
21443 int system(const char *command);
21444
21445 @exdent Request:
21446 Fsystem,commandptr/len
21447
21448 @exdent Return value:
21449 The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
21450 of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
21451 command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
21452 system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
21453 In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
21454
21455 @exdent Errors:
21456 @end smallexample
21457
21458 @table @code
21459 @item EINTR
21460 The call was interrupted by the user.
21461 @end table
21462
21463 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21464 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21465 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21466
21467 @menu
21468 * Integral datatypes::
21469 * Pointer values::
21470 * struct stat::
21471 * struct timeval::
21472 @end menu
21473
21474 @node Integral datatypes
21475 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
21476 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21477
21478 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
21479
21480 @smallexample
21481 int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
21482 @end smallexample
21483
21484 @code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
21485 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
21486
21487 @code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
21488
21489 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
21490 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
21491
21492 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
21493
21494 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
21495 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
21496 byte order.
21497
21498 @node Pointer values
21499 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
21500 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
21501
21502 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
21503 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
21504 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
21505 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
21506
21507 @smallexample
21508 @code{1aaf/12}
21509 @end smallexample
21510
21511 @noindent
21512 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
21513 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
21514 the trailing null byte. Example:
21515
21516 @smallexample
21517 ``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
21518 @end smallexample
21519
21520 @noindent
21521 is transmitted as
21522
21523 @smallexample
21524 @code{123456/d}
21525 @end smallexample
21526
21527 @node struct stat
21528 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
21529 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
21530
21531 The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
21532 as follows:
21533
21534 @smallexample
21535 struct stat @{
21536 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
21537 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
21538 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
21539 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
21540 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
21541 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
21542 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
21543 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
21544 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
21545 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
21546 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
21547 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
21548 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
21549 @};
21550 @end smallexample
21551
21552 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21553 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21554 structure is of size 64 bytes.
21555
21556 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
21557 range of values.
21558
21559 @smallexample
21560 st_dev: 0 file
21561 1 console
21562
21563 st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21564
21565 st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
21566 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
21567
21568 st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21569
21570 st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21571
21572 st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21573
21574 st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
21575 These values have a host and file system dependent
21576 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
21577 don't support exact timing values.
21578 @end smallexample
21579
21580 The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
21581 responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
21582 continuing.
21583
21584 Note that due to size differences between the host and target
21585 representation of stat members, these members could eventually
21586 get truncated on the target.
21587
21588 @node struct timeval
21589 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
21590 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
21591
21592 The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
21593 is defined as follows:
21594
21595 @smallexample
21596 struct timeval @{
21597 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
21598 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
21599 @};
21600 @end smallexample
21601
21602 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21603 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21604 structure is of size 8 bytes.
21605
21606 @node Constants
21607 @subsection Constants
21608 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
21609
21610 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
21611 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
21612 values before and after the call as needed.
21613
21614 @menu
21615 * Open flags::
21616 * mode_t values::
21617 * Errno values::
21618 * Lseek flags::
21619 * Limits::
21620 @end menu
21621
21622 @node Open flags
21623 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
21624 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
21625
21626 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
21627
21628 @smallexample
21629 O_RDONLY 0x0
21630 O_WRONLY 0x1
21631 O_RDWR 0x2
21632 O_APPEND 0x8
21633 O_CREAT 0x200
21634 O_TRUNC 0x400
21635 O_EXCL 0x800
21636 @end smallexample
21637
21638 @node mode_t values
21639 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
21640 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
21641
21642 All values are given in octal representation.
21643
21644 @smallexample
21645 S_IFREG 0100000
21646 S_IFDIR 040000
21647 S_IRUSR 0400
21648 S_IWUSR 0200
21649 S_IXUSR 0100
21650 S_IRGRP 040
21651 S_IWGRP 020
21652 S_IXGRP 010
21653 S_IROTH 04
21654 S_IWOTH 02
21655 S_IXOTH 01
21656 @end smallexample
21657
21658 @node Errno values
21659 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
21660 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
21661
21662 All values are given in decimal representation.
21663
21664 @smallexample
21665 EPERM 1
21666 ENOENT 2
21667 EINTR 4
21668 EBADF 9
21669 EACCES 13
21670 EFAULT 14
21671 EBUSY 16
21672 EEXIST 17
21673 ENODEV 19
21674 ENOTDIR 20
21675 EISDIR 21
21676 EINVAL 22
21677 ENFILE 23
21678 EMFILE 24
21679 EFBIG 27
21680 ENOSPC 28
21681 ESPIPE 29
21682 EROFS 30
21683 ENAMETOOLONG 91
21684 EUNKNOWN 9999
21685 @end smallexample
21686
21687 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
21688 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
21689
21690 @node Lseek flags
21691 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
21692 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
21693
21694 @smallexample
21695 SEEK_SET 0
21696 SEEK_CUR 1
21697 SEEK_END 2
21698 @end smallexample
21699
21700 @node Limits
21701 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
21702 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
21703
21704 All values are given in decimal representation.
21705
21706 @smallexample
21707 INT_MIN -2147483648
21708 INT_MAX 2147483647
21709 UINT_MAX 4294967295
21710 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
21711 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
21712 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
21713 @end smallexample
21714
21715 @node File-I/O Examples
21716 @subsection File-I/O Examples
21717 @cindex file-i/o examples
21718
21719 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21720 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
21721
21722 @smallexample
21723 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
21724 @emph{request memory read from target}
21725 -> @code{m1234,6}
21726 <- XXXXXX
21727 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
21728 -> @code{F6}
21729 @end smallexample
21730
21731 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21732 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
21733
21734 @smallexample
21735 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21736 @emph{request memory write to target}
21737 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21738 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
21739 -> @code{F6}
21740 @end smallexample
21741
21742 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
21743 file descriptor (EBADF):
21744
21745 @smallexample
21746 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21747 -> @code{F-1,9}
21748 @end smallexample
21749
21750 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
21751 host is called:
21752
21753 @smallexample
21754 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21755 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
21756 <- @code{T02}
21757 @end smallexample
21758
21759 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
21760 host is called:
21761
21762 @smallexample
21763 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21764 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21765 <- @code{T02}
21766 @end smallexample
21767
21768 @include agentexpr.texi
21769
21770 @include gpl.texi
21771
21772 @include fdl.texi
21773
21774 @node Index
21775 @unnumbered Index
21776
21777 @printindex cp
21778
21779 @tex
21780 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
21781 % meantime:
21782 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
21783 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
21784 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
21785 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
21786 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
21787 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
21788 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
21789 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
21790 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
21791 \page\colophon
21792 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
21793 @end tex
21794
21795 @bye
This page took 0.485575 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.